(Special Diary Entries): Fix Thanksgiving example.
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blob5bfd95b8aaf23400e224c5091626776d63375608
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
25 #include <config.h>
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
31 #include <stdio.h>
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
134 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
135 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
136 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
137 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
138 #ifndef XtNpickTop
139 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
140 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
141 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
142 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
144 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
146 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
147 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
148 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
149 #endif
151 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
152 #include "widget.h"
153 #ifndef XtNinitialState
154 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
155 #endif
156 #endif
158 #undef abs
159 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
161 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
162 #ifdef USE_XIM
163 int use_xim = 1;
164 #else
165 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
166 #endif
170 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
172 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
174 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
175 start. */
177 static int any_help_event_p;
179 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
180 static Lisp_Object last_window;
182 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
184 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
186 /* Non-zero means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line. */
188 int x_underline_at_descent_line;
190 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
191 use. */
193 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
195 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
196 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
197 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
198 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
200 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
202 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
203 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
204 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
205 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
207 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
209 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
211 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
213 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
214 /* The application context for Xt use. */
215 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
216 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
217 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
219 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
221 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
223 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
224 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
226 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
228 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
229 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
230 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
232 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
234 /* Mouse movement.
236 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
237 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
238 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
239 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
241 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
243 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
244 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
245 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
246 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
247 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
248 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
249 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
250 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
251 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
252 is off. */
254 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
256 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
257 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
258 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
260 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
262 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
263 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
264 an ordinary motion.
266 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
267 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
268 event. */
270 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
272 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
273 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
274 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
275 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
276 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
277 it's somewhat accurate. */
279 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
281 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
283 static Time last_user_time;
285 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
286 events. */
288 #ifdef __STDC__
289 static int volatile input_signal_count;
290 #else
291 static int input_signal_count;
292 #endif
294 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
296 static int x_noop_count;
298 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
300 extern char **initial_argv;
301 extern int initial_argc;
303 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
305 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
307 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
309 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
311 extern int errno;
313 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
315 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
317 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
319 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
320 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
321 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
323 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
324 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
326 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
327 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
329 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
330 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
331 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
332 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
334 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
335 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
336 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
337 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
338 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
339 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
340 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
341 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
342 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
343 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
344 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
345 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
346 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
347 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
348 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
349 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
350 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
351 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
352 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
353 enum text_cursor_kinds));
355 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC));
356 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
357 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
358 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
359 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
360 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
361 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
362 enum scroll_bar_part *,
363 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
364 unsigned long *));
365 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
366 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *, int, int));
367 static void x_sync_with_move P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
368 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
369 int *, struct input_event *));
370 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
371 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
372 static SIGTYPE x_connection_closed P_ ((Display *, char *));
375 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
377 static void
378 x_flush (f)
379 struct frame *f;
381 BLOCK_INPUT;
382 if (f == NULL)
384 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
385 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
386 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
388 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
389 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
390 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
394 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
395 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
396 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
397 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
398 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
399 performance. */
401 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
404 /***********************************************************************
405 Debugging
406 ***********************************************************************/
408 #if 0
410 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
411 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
413 struct record
415 char *locus;
416 int type;
419 struct record event_record[100];
421 int event_record_index;
423 record_event (locus, type)
424 char *locus;
425 int type;
427 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
428 event_record_index = 0;
430 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
431 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
432 event_record_index++;
435 #endif /* 0 */
439 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
441 struct x_display_info *
442 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
443 Display *dpy;
445 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
447 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
448 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
449 return dpyinfo;
451 return 0;
456 /***********************************************************************
457 Starting and ending an update
458 ***********************************************************************/
460 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
461 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
462 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
463 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
464 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
466 static void
467 x_update_begin (f)
468 struct frame *f;
470 /* Nothing to do. */
474 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
475 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
476 position of W. */
478 static void
479 x_update_window_begin (w)
480 struct window *w;
482 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
483 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
485 updated_window = w;
486 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
488 BLOCK_INPUT;
490 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
492 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
493 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
495 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
496 highlighting. */
497 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
498 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
500 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
501 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
502 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
503 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
504 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
505 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
507 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
508 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
509 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
510 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
511 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
512 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
513 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
515 int i;
517 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
518 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
519 break;
521 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
522 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
524 #endif /* 0 */
527 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
531 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
533 static void
534 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
535 struct window *w;
536 int x, y0, y1;
538 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
539 struct face *face;
541 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
542 if (face)
543 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
544 face->foreground);
546 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
547 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
550 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
552 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
553 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
555 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
556 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
557 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
559 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
560 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
561 here. */
563 static void
564 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
565 struct window *w;
566 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
568 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
570 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
572 BLOCK_INPUT;
574 if (cursor_on_p)
575 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
576 output_cursor.vpos,
577 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
579 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
580 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
582 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
585 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
586 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
587 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
589 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
590 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
591 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
594 updated_window = NULL;
598 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
599 update_end. */
601 static void
602 x_update_end (f)
603 struct frame *f;
605 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
606 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
608 #ifndef XFlush
609 BLOCK_INPUT;
610 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
611 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
612 #endif
616 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
617 complete update has been performed. The global variable
618 updated_window is not available here. */
620 static void
621 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
622 struct frame *f;
624 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
626 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
628 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
629 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
631 BLOCK_INPUT;
632 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
633 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
634 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
635 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
636 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
637 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
643 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
644 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
645 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
646 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
647 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
648 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
650 static void
651 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
652 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
654 struct window *w = updated_window;
655 struct frame *f;
656 int width, height;
658 xassert (w);
660 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
661 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
663 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
664 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
665 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
666 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
667 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
668 overhead is very small. */
669 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
670 && desired_row->full_width_p
671 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
672 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
673 width != 0)
674 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
675 height > 0))
677 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
679 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
680 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
681 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
682 y -= width;
684 BLOCK_INPUT;
685 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
686 0, y, width, height, False);
687 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
688 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
689 y, width, height, False);
690 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
694 static void
695 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
696 struct window *w;
697 struct glyph_row *row;
698 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
700 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
701 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
702 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
703 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
704 struct face *face = p->face;
705 int rowY;
707 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
708 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
709 if (p->y < rowY)
711 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
712 visible last row. */
713 int oldY = row->y;
714 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
715 row->visible_height = p->h;
716 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
717 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
718 row->y = oldY;
719 row->visible_height = oldVH;
721 else
722 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
724 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
726 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
727 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
728 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
729 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
730 if (face->stipple)
731 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
732 else
733 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
735 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
736 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
738 if (!face->stipple)
739 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
742 if (p->which)
744 unsigned char *bits;
745 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
746 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
747 XGCValues gcv;
749 if (p->wd > 8)
750 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
751 else
752 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
754 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
755 by the server. */
756 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
757 (p->cursor_p
758 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
759 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
760 : face->foreground),
761 face->background, depth);
763 if (p->overlay_p)
765 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
766 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
767 bits, p->wd, p->h,
768 1, 0, 1);
769 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
770 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
771 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
772 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
775 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
776 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
777 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
779 if (p->overlay_p)
781 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
782 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
783 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
787 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
792 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
793 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
794 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
795 rarely happens). */
797 static void
798 XTset_terminal_modes ()
802 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
803 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
805 static void
806 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
812 /***********************************************************************
813 Display Iterator
814 ***********************************************************************/
816 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
818 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
821 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
822 is not contained in the font. */
824 static XCharStruct *
825 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
826 XFontStruct *font;
827 XChar2b *char2b;
828 int font_type; /* unused on X */
830 /* The result metric information. */
831 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
833 xassert (font && char2b);
835 if (font->per_char != NULL)
837 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
839 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
840 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
841 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
842 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
843 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
844 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
845 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
846 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
847 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
848 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
850 else
852 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
853 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
854 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
855 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
857 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
858 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
860 where:
862 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
863 / = integer division
864 \ = integer modulus */
865 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
866 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
867 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
868 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
870 pcm = (font->per_char
871 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
872 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
873 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
877 else
879 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
880 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
881 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
882 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
883 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
884 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
887 return ((pcm == NULL
888 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
889 ? NULL : pcm);
893 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
894 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
896 static int
897 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
898 int c;
899 XChar2b *char2b;
900 struct font_info *font_info;
901 int *two_byte_p;
903 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
904 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
906 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
907 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
908 fixed encoding. */
909 if (font_info->font_encoder)
911 /* It's a program. */
912 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
914 check_ccl_update (ccl);
915 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
917 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
918 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
919 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
921 else
923 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
924 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
925 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
928 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
930 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
931 program. */
932 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
933 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
934 else
935 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
937 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
939 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
940 encoding numbers. */
941 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
943 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
944 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
945 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
947 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
948 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
951 if (two_byte_p)
952 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
954 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
959 /***********************************************************************
960 Glyph display
961 ***********************************************************************/
965 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
966 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
967 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
968 int));
969 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
970 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
971 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
972 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
973 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
974 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
975 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
976 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
977 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
978 unsigned long *, double, int));
979 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
980 double, int, unsigned long));
981 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
982 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
983 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
984 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
985 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
986 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
987 int, int, int));
988 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
989 int, int, int, int, int, int,
990 XRectangle *));
991 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
992 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
994 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
995 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
996 #endif
999 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
1000 face. */
1002 static void
1003 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
1004 struct glyph_string *s;
1006 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
1007 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1008 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1009 && !s->cmp)
1010 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
1011 else
1013 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
1014 XGCValues xgcv;
1015 unsigned long mask;
1017 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1018 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1020 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1021 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1022 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1023 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1024 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1025 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1026 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1028 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1029 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1030 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1032 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1033 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1036 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1037 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1038 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1039 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1041 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1042 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1043 mask, &xgcv);
1044 else
1045 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1046 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1048 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1053 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1055 static void
1056 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1057 struct glyph_string *s;
1059 int face_id;
1060 struct face *face;
1062 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1063 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1064 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1065 if (face == NULL)
1066 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1068 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1069 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1070 else
1071 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1072 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1073 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1075 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1076 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1077 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1078 else
1080 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1081 but font FONT. */
1082 XGCValues xgcv;
1083 unsigned long mask;
1085 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1086 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1087 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1088 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1089 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1090 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1092 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1093 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1094 mask, &xgcv);
1095 else
1096 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1097 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1099 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1102 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1106 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1107 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1108 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1110 static INLINE void
1111 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1112 struct glyph_string *s;
1114 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1118 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1119 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1120 pattern. */
1122 static INLINE void
1123 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1124 struct glyph_string *s;
1126 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1128 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1130 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1131 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1133 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1135 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1136 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1138 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1140 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1141 s->stippled_p = 0;
1143 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1145 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1146 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1148 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1149 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1151 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1152 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1154 else
1156 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1157 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1160 /* GC must have been set. */
1161 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1165 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1166 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1168 static INLINE void
1169 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1170 struct glyph_string *s;
1172 XRectangle r;
1173 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1174 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1178 /* RIF:
1179 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1180 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1182 static void
1183 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1184 struct glyph_string *s;
1186 if (s->cmp == NULL
1187 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1189 XCharStruct cs;
1190 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1191 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1192 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1193 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1194 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1199 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1201 static INLINE void
1202 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1203 struct glyph_string *s;
1204 int x, y, w, h;
1206 XGCValues xgcv;
1207 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1208 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1209 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1210 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1214 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1215 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1216 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1217 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1218 contains the first component of a composition. */
1220 static void
1221 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1222 struct glyph_string *s;
1223 int force_p;
1225 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1226 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1227 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1229 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1231 if (s->stippled_p)
1233 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1234 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1235 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1236 s->y + box_line_width,
1237 s->background_width,
1238 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1239 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1240 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1242 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1243 || s->font_not_found_p
1244 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1245 || force_p)
1247 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1248 s->background_width,
1249 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1250 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1256 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1258 static void
1259 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1260 struct glyph_string *s;
1262 int i, x;
1264 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1265 of S to the right of that box line. */
1266 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1267 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1268 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1269 else
1270 x = s->x;
1272 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1273 loaded. */
1274 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1276 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1278 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1279 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1280 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1281 s->height - 1);
1282 x += g->pixel_width;
1285 else
1287 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1288 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1290 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1291 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1293 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1294 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1295 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1296 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1298 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1299 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1300 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1301 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1302 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1303 if (s->for_overlaps
1304 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1306 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1307 if (s->two_byte_p)
1308 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1309 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1310 else
1311 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1312 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1314 else
1316 if (s->two_byte_p)
1317 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1318 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1319 else
1320 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1321 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1324 if (s->face->overstrike)
1326 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1327 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1328 if (s->two_byte_p)
1329 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1330 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1331 else
1332 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1333 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1338 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1340 static void
1341 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1342 struct glyph_string *s;
1344 int i, x;
1346 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1347 of S to the right of that box line. */
1348 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1349 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1350 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1351 else
1352 x = s->x;
1354 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1355 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1356 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1357 this composition. */
1359 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1360 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1361 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1363 if (s->gidx == 0)
1364 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1365 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1367 else
1369 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1371 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1372 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1373 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1374 s->char2b + i, 1);
1375 if (s->face->overstrike)
1376 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1377 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1378 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1379 s->char2b + i, 1);
1385 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1387 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1388 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1389 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1390 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1391 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1394 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1395 cannot be determined. */
1397 static struct frame *
1398 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1399 Widget widget;
1401 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1402 Lisp_Object tail;
1403 struct frame *f;
1405 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1407 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1408 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1409 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1410 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1411 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1412 widget = XtParent (widget);
1414 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1415 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1416 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1417 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1418 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1419 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1420 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1421 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1422 return f;
1424 abort ();
1428 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1429 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1430 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1431 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1434 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1435 Widget widget;
1436 Colormap cmap;
1437 XColor *color;
1439 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1440 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1444 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1445 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1446 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1447 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1448 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1449 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1452 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1453 Widget widget;
1454 Display *display;
1455 Colormap cmap;
1456 unsigned long *pixel;
1457 double factor;
1458 int delta;
1460 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1461 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1465 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1466 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1468 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1470 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1471 sizeof (Screen *)},
1472 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1473 sizeof (Colormap)}
1477 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1478 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1480 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1483 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1485 DPY is the display we are working on.
1487 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1488 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1489 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1490 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1492 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1493 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1495 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1496 we allocated the color or not.
1498 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1500 static Boolean
1501 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1502 Display *dpy;
1503 XrmValue *args;
1504 Cardinal *nargs;
1505 XrmValue *from, *to;
1506 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1508 Screen *screen;
1509 Colormap cmap;
1510 Pixel pixel;
1511 String color_name;
1512 XColor color;
1514 if (*nargs != 2)
1516 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1517 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1518 "XtToolkitError",
1519 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1520 return False;
1523 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1524 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1525 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1527 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1529 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1530 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1532 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1534 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1535 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1537 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1538 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1540 pixel = color.pixel;
1541 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1543 else
1545 String params[1];
1546 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1548 params[0] = color_name;
1549 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1550 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1551 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1552 params, &nparams);
1553 return False;
1556 if (to->addr != NULL)
1558 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1560 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1561 return False;
1564 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1566 else
1568 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1569 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1572 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1573 return True;
1577 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1578 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1579 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1581 APP is the application context in which we work.
1583 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1584 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1585 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1587 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1589 static void
1590 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1591 XtAppContext app;
1592 XrmValuePtr to;
1593 XtPointer closure;
1594 XrmValuePtr args;
1595 Cardinal *nargs;
1597 if (*nargs != 2)
1599 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1600 "XtToolkitError",
1601 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1602 NULL, NULL);
1604 else if (closure != NULL)
1606 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1607 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1608 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1609 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1610 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1615 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1618 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1619 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1620 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1621 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1623 static const XColor *
1624 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1625 Display *dpy;
1626 int *ncells;
1628 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1630 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1632 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1633 int i;
1635 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1636 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1637 dpyinfo->color_cells
1638 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1639 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1641 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1642 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1644 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1645 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1648 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1649 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1653 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1654 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1656 void
1657 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1658 struct frame *f;
1659 XColor *colors;
1660 int ncolors;
1662 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1664 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1666 int i;
1667 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1669 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1670 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1671 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1672 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1675 else
1676 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1680 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1681 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1683 void
1684 x_query_color (f, color)
1685 struct frame *f;
1686 XColor *color;
1688 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1692 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1693 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1694 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1695 allocated. */
1697 static int
1698 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1699 Display *dpy;
1700 Colormap cmap;
1701 XColor *color;
1703 int rc;
1705 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1706 if (rc == 0)
1708 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1709 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1710 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1711 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1712 int nearest, i;
1713 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1714 int ncells;
1715 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1717 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1719 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1720 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1721 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1722 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1724 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1726 nearest = i;
1727 nearest_delta = delta;
1731 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1732 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1733 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1734 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1736 else
1738 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1739 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1740 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1741 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1742 XColor *cached_color;
1744 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1745 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1746 (cached_color->red != color->red
1747 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1748 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1750 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1751 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1752 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1756 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1757 if (rc)
1758 register_color (color->pixel);
1759 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1761 return rc;
1765 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1766 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1767 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1768 allocated. */
1771 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1772 struct frame *f;
1773 Colormap cmap;
1774 XColor *color;
1776 gamma_correct (f, color);
1777 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1781 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1782 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1783 get color reference counts right. */
1785 unsigned long
1786 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1787 struct frame *f;
1788 unsigned long pixel;
1790 XColor color;
1792 color.pixel = pixel;
1793 BLOCK_INPUT;
1794 x_query_color (f, &color);
1795 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1796 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1797 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1798 register_color (pixel);
1799 #endif
1800 return color.pixel;
1804 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1805 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1806 get color reference counts right. */
1808 unsigned long
1809 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1810 Display *dpy;
1811 Colormap cmap;
1812 unsigned long pixel;
1814 XColor color;
1816 color.pixel = pixel;
1817 BLOCK_INPUT;
1818 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1819 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1820 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1821 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1822 register_color (pixel);
1823 #endif
1824 return color.pixel;
1828 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1829 boosted.
1831 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1832 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1833 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1834 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1835 use an additional additive factor.
1837 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1838 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1839 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1842 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1843 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1844 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1845 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1846 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1847 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1849 static int
1850 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1851 struct frame *f;
1852 Display *display;
1853 Colormap cmap;
1854 unsigned long *pixel;
1855 double factor;
1856 int delta;
1858 XColor color, new;
1859 long bright;
1860 int success_p;
1862 /* Get RGB color values. */
1863 color.pixel = *pixel;
1864 x_query_color (f, &color);
1866 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1867 xassert (factor >= 0);
1868 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1869 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1870 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1872 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1873 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1875 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1876 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1877 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1878 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1879 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1881 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1882 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1883 /* The additive adjustment. */
1884 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1886 if (factor < 1)
1888 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1889 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1890 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1892 else
1894 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1895 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1896 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1900 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1901 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1902 if (success_p)
1904 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1906 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1907 delta to the RGB values. */
1908 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1910 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1911 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1912 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1913 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1915 else
1916 success_p = 1;
1917 *pixel = new.pixel;
1920 return success_p;
1924 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1925 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1926 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1927 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1928 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1929 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1931 static void
1932 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1933 struct frame *f;
1934 struct relief *relief;
1935 double factor;
1936 int delta;
1937 unsigned long default_pixel;
1939 XGCValues xgcv;
1940 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1941 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1942 unsigned long pixel;
1943 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1944 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1945 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1946 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1948 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1949 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1951 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1952 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1953 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1954 if (relief->gc
1955 && relief->allocated_p)
1957 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1958 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1961 /* Allocate new color. */
1962 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1963 pixel = background;
1964 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1965 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1967 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1968 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1971 if (relief->gc == 0)
1973 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1974 mask |= GCStipple;
1975 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1977 else
1978 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1982 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1984 static void
1985 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1986 struct glyph_string *s;
1988 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1989 unsigned long color;
1991 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1992 color = s->face->box_color;
1993 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1994 && s->img->pixmap
1995 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1996 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1997 else
1999 XGCValues xgcv;
2001 /* Get the background color of the face. */
2002 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
2003 color = xgcv.background;
2006 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2007 || color != di->relief_background)
2009 di->relief_background = color;
2010 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2011 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2012 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2013 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2018 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2019 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2020 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2021 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2022 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2023 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2024 when drawing. */
2026 static void
2027 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2028 raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2029 struct frame *f;
2030 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width;
2031 int top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2032 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2034 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2035 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2036 int i;
2037 GC gc;
2039 if (raised_p)
2040 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2041 else
2042 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2043 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2045 /* Top. */
2046 if (top_p)
2047 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2048 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2049 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2050 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2052 /* Left. */
2053 if (left_p)
2054 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2055 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2056 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2058 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2059 if (raised_p)
2060 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2061 else
2062 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2063 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2065 /* Bottom. */
2066 if (bot_p)
2067 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2068 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2069 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2070 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2072 /* Right. */
2073 if (right_p)
2074 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2075 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2076 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2078 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2082 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2083 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2084 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2085 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2086 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2087 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2089 static void
2090 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2091 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2092 struct glyph_string *s;
2093 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2094 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2096 XGCValues xgcv;
2098 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2099 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2100 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2102 /* Top. */
2103 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2104 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2106 /* Left. */
2107 if (left_p)
2108 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2109 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2111 /* Bottom. */
2112 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2113 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2115 /* Right. */
2116 if (right_p)
2117 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2118 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2120 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2121 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2125 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2127 static void
2128 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2129 struct glyph_string *s;
2131 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2132 int left_p, right_p;
2133 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2134 XRectangle clip_rect;
2136 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2137 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2138 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2140 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2141 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2142 ? s->first_glyph
2143 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2145 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2146 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2147 left_x = s->x;
2148 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2149 ? last_x - 1
2150 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2151 top_y = s->y;
2152 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2154 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2155 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2156 && (s->prev == NULL
2157 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2158 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2159 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2160 && (s->next == NULL
2161 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2163 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2165 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2166 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2167 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2168 else
2170 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2171 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2172 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2177 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2179 static void
2180 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2181 struct glyph_string *s;
2183 int x = s->x;
2184 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2186 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2187 right of that line. */
2188 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2189 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2190 && s->slice.x == 0)
2191 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2193 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2194 by that margin. */
2195 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2196 x += s->img->hmargin;
2197 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2198 y += s->img->vmargin;
2200 if (s->img->pixmap)
2202 if (s->img->mask)
2204 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2205 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2206 trust on the shape extension to be available
2207 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2208 manually. */
2209 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2210 | GCFunction);
2211 XGCValues xgcv;
2212 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2214 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2215 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2216 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2217 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2218 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2220 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2221 image_rect.x = x;
2222 image_rect.y = y;
2223 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2224 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2225 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2226 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2227 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2228 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2230 else
2232 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2234 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2235 image_rect.x = x;
2236 image_rect.y = y;
2237 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2238 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2239 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2240 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2241 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2242 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2244 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2245 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2246 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2247 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2248 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2249 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2250 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2252 int r = s->img->relief;
2253 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2254 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2255 x - r, y - r,
2256 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2257 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2261 else
2262 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2263 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2264 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2268 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2270 static void
2271 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2272 struct glyph_string *s;
2274 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2275 XRectangle r;
2276 int x = s->x;
2277 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2279 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2280 right of that line. */
2281 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2282 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2283 && s->slice.x == 0)
2284 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2286 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2287 by that margin. */
2288 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2289 x += s->img->hmargin;
2290 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2291 y += s->img->vmargin;
2293 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2294 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2296 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2297 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2299 else
2301 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2302 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2305 x0 = x - thick;
2306 y0 = y - thick;
2307 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1;
2308 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1;
2310 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2311 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2312 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2313 s->slice.y == 0,
2314 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2315 s->slice.x == 0,
2316 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2317 &r);
2321 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2323 static void
2324 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2325 struct glyph_string *s;
2326 Pixmap pixmap;
2328 int x = 0;
2329 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2331 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2332 right of that line. */
2333 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2334 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2335 && s->slice.x == 0)
2336 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2338 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2339 by that margin. */
2340 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2341 x += s->img->hmargin;
2342 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2343 y += s->img->vmargin;
2345 if (s->img->pixmap)
2347 if (s->img->mask)
2349 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2350 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2351 trust on the shape extension to be available
2352 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2353 manually. */
2354 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2355 | GCFunction);
2356 XGCValues xgcv;
2358 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2359 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2360 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2361 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2362 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2364 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2365 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2366 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2367 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2369 else
2371 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2372 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2373 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2375 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2376 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2377 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2378 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2379 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2380 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2381 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2383 int r = s->img->relief;
2384 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2385 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2386 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2387 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2391 else
2392 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2393 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2394 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2398 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2399 give the rectangle to draw. */
2401 static void
2402 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2403 struct glyph_string *s;
2404 int x, y, w, h;
2406 if (s->stippled_p)
2408 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2409 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2410 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2411 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2413 else
2414 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2418 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2420 s->y
2421 s->x +-------------------------
2422 | s->face->box
2424 | +-------------------------
2425 | | s->img->margin
2427 | | +-------------------
2428 | | | the image
2432 static void
2433 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2434 struct glyph_string *s;
2436 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2437 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2438 int height;
2439 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2441 height = s->height;
2442 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2443 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2444 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2445 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2447 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2448 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2449 flickering. */
2450 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2451 if (height > s->slice.height
2452 || s->img->hmargin
2453 || s->img->vmargin
2454 || s->img->mask
2455 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2456 || s->width != s->background_width)
2458 if (s->img->mask)
2460 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2461 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2462 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2463 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2464 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2466 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2467 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2468 s->background_width,
2469 s->height, depth);
2471 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2472 pixmap. */
2473 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2475 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2476 if (s->stippled_p)
2478 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2479 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2480 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2481 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2482 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2483 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2484 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2486 else
2488 XGCValues xgcv;
2489 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2490 &xgcv);
2491 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2492 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2493 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2494 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2497 else
2499 int x = s->x;
2500 int y = s->y;
2502 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2503 && s->slice.x == 0)
2504 x += box_line_hwidth;
2506 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2507 y += box_line_vwidth;
2509 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2512 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2515 /* Draw the foreground. */
2516 if (pixmap != None)
2518 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2519 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2520 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2521 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2522 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2524 else
2525 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2527 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2528 if (s->img->relief
2529 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2530 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2531 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2535 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2537 static void
2538 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2539 struct glyph_string *s;
2541 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2543 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2544 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2546 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2547 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2548 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2549 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2551 if (x < left_x)
2553 background_width -= left_x - x;
2554 x = left_x;
2556 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2558 /* Draw cursor. */
2559 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2561 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2562 if (width < background_width)
2564 int y = s->y;
2565 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2566 XRectangle r;
2567 GC gc;
2569 x += width;
2570 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2571 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2573 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2574 gc = s->gc;
2576 else
2577 gc = s->face->gc;
2579 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2580 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2582 if (s->face->stipple)
2584 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2585 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2586 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2587 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2589 else
2591 XGCValues xgcv;
2592 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2593 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2594 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2595 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2599 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2601 int background_width = s->background_width;
2602 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2604 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2605 except for header line and mode line. */
2606 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2608 background_width -= left_x - x;
2609 x = left_x;
2611 if (background_width > 0)
2612 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2615 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2619 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2621 static void
2622 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2623 struct glyph_string *s;
2625 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2627 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2628 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2629 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2630 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2632 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2633 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2634 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2635 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2638 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2639 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2641 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2642 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2643 if (!s->for_overlaps
2644 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2645 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2646 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2649 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2650 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2651 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2652 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2653 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2655 else
2656 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2658 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2660 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2661 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2662 break;
2664 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2665 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2666 break;
2668 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2669 if (s->for_overlaps)
2670 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2671 else
2672 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2673 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2674 break;
2676 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2677 if (s->for_overlaps || s->gidx > 0)
2678 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2679 else
2680 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2681 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2682 break;
2684 default:
2685 abort ();
2688 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2690 /* Draw underline. */
2691 if (s->face->underline_p)
2693 unsigned long tem, h;
2694 int y;
2696 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2697 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2698 h = 1;
2700 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2701 if (!x_underline_at_descent_line)
2703 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2704 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2705 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2706 specs, and its default is
2708 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2709 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2711 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2712 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2713 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2714 else if (s->face->font)
2715 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2718 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2719 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2720 s->x, y, s->background_width, h);
2721 else
2723 XGCValues xgcv;
2724 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2725 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2726 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2727 s->x, y, s->background_width, h);
2728 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2732 /* Draw overline. */
2733 if (s->face->overline_p)
2735 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2737 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2738 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2739 s->background_width, h);
2740 else
2742 XGCValues xgcv;
2743 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2744 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2745 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2746 s->background_width, h);
2747 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2751 /* Draw strike-through. */
2752 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2754 unsigned long h = 1;
2755 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2757 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2758 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2759 s->width, h);
2760 else
2762 XGCValues xgcv;
2763 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2764 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2765 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2766 s->width, h);
2767 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2771 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2772 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2773 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2776 /* Reset clipping. */
2777 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2780 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2782 void
2783 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2784 struct frame *f;
2785 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2787 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2788 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2789 x, y, width, height,
2790 x + shift_by, y);
2793 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2794 for X frames. */
2796 static void
2797 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2798 register int n;
2800 abort ();
2804 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2805 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2807 void
2808 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2809 Display *dpy;
2810 Window window;
2811 int x, y;
2812 int width, height;
2813 int exposures;
2815 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2816 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2820 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2821 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2823 static void
2824 x_clear_frame ()
2826 struct frame *f;
2828 if (updating_frame)
2829 f = updating_frame;
2830 else
2831 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2833 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2834 longer visible. */
2835 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2836 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2837 output_cursor.x = -1;
2839 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2840 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2841 BLOCK_INPUT;
2842 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2844 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2845 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2846 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2848 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2850 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2855 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2857 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2858 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2860 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2863 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2864 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2866 static int
2867 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2868 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2870 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2871 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2872 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2874 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2875 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2876 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2879 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2881 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2882 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2883 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2886 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2887 positive. */
2888 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2889 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2891 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2892 negative. */
2893 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2896 void
2897 XTflash (f)
2898 struct frame *f;
2900 BLOCK_INPUT;
2903 GC gc;
2905 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2906 pixels into background pixels. */
2908 XGCValues values;
2910 values.function = GXxor;
2911 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2912 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2914 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2915 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2919 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2920 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2921 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2922 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2923 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2924 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2925 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2927 int width;
2929 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2930 edge it is next to. */
2931 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2933 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2934 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2935 break;
2937 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2938 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2939 break;
2941 default:
2942 break;
2945 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2947 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2948 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2950 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2951 flash_left,
2952 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2953 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2954 width, flash_height);
2955 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2956 flash_left,
2957 (height - flash_height
2958 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2959 width, flash_height);
2961 else
2962 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2963 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2964 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2965 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2967 x_flush (f);
2970 struct timeval wakeup;
2972 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2974 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2975 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2976 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2977 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2979 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2980 available. */
2981 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2983 struct timeval current;
2984 struct timeval timeout;
2986 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2988 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2989 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2990 break;
2992 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2993 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2994 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2996 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2997 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3001 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3002 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3004 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3005 flash_left,
3006 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3007 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
3008 width, flash_height);
3009 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3010 flash_left,
3011 (height - flash_height
3012 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3013 width, flash_height);
3015 else
3016 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3017 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3018 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3019 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3021 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3022 x_flush (f);
3026 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3029 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3032 /* Make audible bell. */
3034 void
3035 XTring_bell ()
3037 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3039 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3041 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3042 if (visible_bell)
3043 XTflash (f);
3044 else
3045 #endif
3047 BLOCK_INPUT;
3048 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3049 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3050 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3056 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3057 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3058 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3059 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3061 static void
3062 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3063 register int n;
3065 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3070 /***********************************************************************
3071 Line Dance
3072 ***********************************************************************/
3074 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3075 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3077 static void
3078 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
3079 int vpos, n;
3081 abort ();
3085 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3087 static void
3088 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3089 struct window *w;
3090 struct run *run;
3092 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3093 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3095 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3096 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3097 fringe of W. */
3098 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3100 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3101 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3102 bottom_y = y + height;
3104 if (to_y < from_y)
3106 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3107 line at the bottom. */
3108 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3109 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3110 else
3111 height = run->height;
3113 else
3115 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3116 at the bottom. */
3117 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3118 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3119 else
3120 height = run->height;
3123 BLOCK_INPUT;
3125 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3126 updated_window = w;
3127 x_clear_cursor (w);
3129 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3130 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3131 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3132 x, from_y,
3133 width, height,
3134 x, to_y);
3136 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3141 /***********************************************************************
3142 Exposure Events
3143 ***********************************************************************/
3146 static void
3147 frame_highlight (f)
3148 struct frame *f;
3150 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3151 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3152 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3153 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3154 BLOCK_INPUT;
3155 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3156 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3157 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3158 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3161 static void
3162 frame_unhighlight (f)
3163 struct frame *f;
3165 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3166 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3167 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3168 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3169 BLOCK_INPUT;
3170 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3171 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3172 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3173 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3176 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3177 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3178 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3179 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3180 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3182 static void
3183 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3184 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3185 struct frame *frame;
3187 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3189 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3191 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3192 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3193 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3195 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3196 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3198 #if 0
3199 selected_frame = frame;
3200 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3201 selected_frame);
3202 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3203 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3204 #endif /* ! 0 */
3206 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3207 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3208 else
3209 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3212 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3215 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3216 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3217 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3219 static void
3220 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3221 int type;
3222 int state;
3223 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3224 struct frame *frame;
3225 struct input_event *bufp;
3227 if (type == FocusIn)
3229 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3231 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3232 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3234 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3235 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3236 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3237 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3238 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3240 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3241 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3245 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3247 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3248 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3249 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3250 #endif
3252 else if (type == FocusOut)
3254 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3256 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3258 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3259 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3262 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3263 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3264 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3265 #endif
3269 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3270 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3272 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3274 static void
3275 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3276 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3277 XEvent *event;
3278 struct input_event *bufp;
3280 struct frame *frame;
3282 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3283 if (! frame)
3284 return;
3286 switch (event->type)
3288 case EnterNotify:
3289 case LeaveNotify:
3291 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3292 int focus_state
3293 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3295 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3296 && event->xcrossing.focus
3297 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3298 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3299 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3300 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3302 break;
3304 case FocusIn:
3305 case FocusOut:
3306 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3307 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3308 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3309 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3310 break;
3315 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3317 void
3318 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3319 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3321 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3324 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3325 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3326 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3328 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3329 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3330 the appropriate X display info. */
3332 static void
3333 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3334 struct frame *frame;
3336 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3339 static void
3340 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3341 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3343 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3345 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3347 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3348 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3349 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3350 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3351 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3353 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3354 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3357 else
3358 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3360 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3362 if (old_highlight)
3363 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3364 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3365 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3371 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3373 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3374 static void
3375 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3376 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3378 int min_code, max_code;
3379 KeySym *syms;
3380 int syms_per_code;
3381 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3383 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3384 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3385 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3386 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3387 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3389 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3390 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3391 #else
3392 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3393 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3394 #endif
3396 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3397 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3398 &syms_per_code);
3399 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3401 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3402 Alt keysyms are on. */
3404 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3405 int found_alt_or_meta;
3407 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3409 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3410 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3412 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3414 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3415 if (code == 0)
3416 continue;
3418 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3420 int code_col;
3422 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3424 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3426 switch (sym)
3428 case XK_Meta_L:
3429 case XK_Meta_R:
3430 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3431 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3432 break;
3434 case XK_Alt_L:
3435 case XK_Alt_R:
3436 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3437 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3438 break;
3440 case XK_Hyper_L:
3441 case XK_Hyper_R:
3442 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3443 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3444 code_col = syms_per_code;
3445 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3446 break;
3448 case XK_Super_L:
3449 case XK_Super_R:
3450 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3451 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3452 code_col = syms_per_code;
3453 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3454 break;
3456 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3457 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3458 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3459 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3460 code_col = syms_per_code;
3461 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3462 break;
3470 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3471 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3473 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3474 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3477 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3478 make them just meta, not alt. */
3479 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3481 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3484 XFree ((char *) syms);
3485 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3488 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3489 Emacs uses. */
3491 unsigned int
3492 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3493 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3494 unsigned int state;
3496 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3497 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3498 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3499 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3500 Lisp_Object tem;
3502 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3503 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3504 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3505 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3506 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3507 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3508 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3509 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3512 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3513 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3514 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3515 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3516 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3517 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3520 static unsigned int
3521 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3522 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3523 unsigned int state;
3525 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3526 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3527 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3528 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3530 Lisp_Object tem;
3532 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3533 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3534 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3535 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3536 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3537 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3538 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3539 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3542 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3543 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3544 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3545 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3546 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3547 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3550 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3552 char *
3553 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3554 KeySym keysym;
3556 char *value;
3558 BLOCK_INPUT;
3559 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3560 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3562 return value;
3567 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3569 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3571 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3572 the mouse. */
3574 static Lisp_Object
3575 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3576 struct input_event *result;
3577 XButtonEvent *event;
3578 struct frame *f;
3580 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3581 otherwise. */
3582 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3583 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3584 result->timestamp = event->time;
3585 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3586 event->state)
3587 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3588 ? up_modifier
3589 : down_modifier));
3591 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3592 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3593 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3594 result->arg = Qnil;
3595 return Qnil;
3599 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3600 The input handler calls this.
3602 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3603 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3604 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3605 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3607 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3608 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3610 static int
3611 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3612 FRAME_PTR frame;
3613 XMotionEvent *event;
3615 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3616 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3617 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3619 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3620 return 0;
3622 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3624 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3625 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3626 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3627 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3628 return 1;
3632 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3633 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3634 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3635 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3636 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3637 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3639 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3640 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3641 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3642 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3643 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3644 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3645 return 1;
3648 return 0;
3652 /************************************************************************
3653 Mouse Face
3654 ************************************************************************/
3656 static void
3657 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3659 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3660 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3661 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3662 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3663 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3668 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3669 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3671 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3672 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3673 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3674 position on the scroll bar.
3676 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3677 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3678 the mouse is over.
3680 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3681 was at this position.
3683 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3685 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3686 movement. */
3688 static void
3689 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3690 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3691 int insist;
3692 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3693 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3694 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3695 unsigned long *time;
3697 FRAME_PTR f1;
3699 BLOCK_INPUT;
3701 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3702 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3703 else
3705 Window root;
3706 int root_x, root_y;
3708 Window dummy_window;
3709 int dummy;
3711 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3713 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3714 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3715 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3716 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3718 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3720 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3721 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3722 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3724 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3725 &root,
3727 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3728 a different screen. */
3729 &dummy_window,
3731 /* The position on that root window. */
3732 &root_x, &root_y,
3734 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3735 &dummy, &dummy,
3737 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3738 we don't care. */
3739 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3741 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3742 containing the pointer. */
3744 Window win, child;
3745 int win_x, win_y;
3746 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3748 win = root;
3750 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3751 structure is changing at the same time this function
3752 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3754 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3756 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3757 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3759 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3760 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3761 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3763 /* From-window, to-window. */
3764 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3766 /* From-position, to-position. */
3767 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3769 /* Child of win. */
3770 &child);
3771 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3773 else
3775 while (1)
3777 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3779 /* From-window, to-window. */
3780 root, win,
3782 /* From-position, to-position. */
3783 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3785 /* Child of win. */
3786 &child);
3788 if (child == None || child == win)
3789 break;
3791 win = child;
3792 parent_x = win_x;
3793 parent_y = win_y;
3796 /* Now we know that:
3797 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3798 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3799 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3800 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3801 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3802 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3803 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3804 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3805 never use them in that case.) */
3807 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3808 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3810 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3811 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3812 on the frame. */
3813 if (f1 != NULL
3814 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3815 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3816 f1 = NULL;
3817 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3820 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3821 f1 = 0;
3823 x_uncatch_errors ();
3825 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3826 if (! f1)
3828 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3830 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3832 if (bar)
3834 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3835 win_x = parent_x;
3836 win_y = parent_y;
3840 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3841 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3843 if (f1)
3845 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3846 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3847 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3848 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3849 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3850 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3851 the frame are divided into. */
3853 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3854 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
3856 *bar_window = Qnil;
3857 *part = 0;
3858 *fp = f1;
3859 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3860 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3861 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3866 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3871 /***********************************************************************
3872 Scroll bars
3873 ***********************************************************************/
3875 /* Scroll bar support. */
3877 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3878 manages it.
3879 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3880 bits. */
3882 static struct scroll_bar *
3883 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
3884 Display *display;
3885 Window window_id;
3887 Lisp_Object tail;
3889 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3890 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3891 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
3893 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3894 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3895 tail = XCDR (tail))
3897 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3899 frame = XCAR (tail);
3900 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3901 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3902 abort ();
3904 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3905 right window ID. */
3906 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3907 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3908 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3909 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3910 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3911 condemned = Qnil,
3912 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3913 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3914 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id &&
3915 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3916 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3919 return 0;
3923 #if defined USE_LUCID
3925 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3926 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3928 static Widget
3929 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3930 Window window;
3932 Lisp_Object tail;
3934 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3935 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3936 tail = XCDR (tail))
3938 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3939 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3941 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3942 return menu_bar;
3945 return NULL;
3948 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3951 /************************************************************************
3952 Toolkit scroll bars
3953 ************************************************************************/
3955 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3957 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3958 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3959 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3960 struct scroll_bar *));
3961 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
3962 int, int, int));
3965 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
3966 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
3968 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
3970 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
3972 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
3974 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
3975 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
3977 #ifndef USE_GTK
3978 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
3980 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
3982 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
3984 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
3985 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
3986 to avoid jerkyness. */
3988 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
3990 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
3991 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
3992 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
3993 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
3995 static void
3996 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
3997 num_params)
3998 Widget widget;
3999 XtPointer client_data;
4000 String action_name;
4001 XEvent *event;
4002 String *params;
4003 Cardinal *num_params;
4005 int scroll_bar_p;
4006 char *end_action;
4008 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4009 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4010 end_action = "Release";
4011 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4012 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4013 end_action = "EndScroll";
4014 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4016 if (scroll_bar_p
4017 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4018 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4020 struct window *w;
4022 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4023 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4024 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4026 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4028 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4029 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4030 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4032 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4033 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4035 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4036 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4039 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4041 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4042 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4044 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4045 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4048 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4049 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4050 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4051 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4053 static void
4054 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4055 Lisp_Object window;
4056 int part, portion, whole;
4058 XEvent event;
4059 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4060 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4061 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4062 int i;
4064 BLOCK_INPUT;
4066 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4067 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4068 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4069 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4070 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4071 ev->format = 32;
4073 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4074 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4075 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4076 into that array in the event. */
4077 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4078 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4079 break;
4081 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4083 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4084 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4085 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4087 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4088 nbytes);
4089 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4090 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4093 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4094 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4095 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4096 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4097 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4098 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4100 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4101 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4102 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4103 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4104 #endif
4106 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4107 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4108 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4109 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4110 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4114 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4115 in *IEVENT. */
4117 static void
4118 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4119 XEvent *event;
4120 struct input_event *ievent;
4122 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4123 Lisp_Object window;
4124 struct frame *f;
4125 struct window *w;
4127 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4128 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4130 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4131 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4133 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4134 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4135 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4136 #ifdef USE_GTK
4137 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4138 #else
4139 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4140 #endif
4141 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4142 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4143 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4144 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4145 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4149 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4151 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4153 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4156 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4157 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4158 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4160 static void
4161 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4162 Widget widget;
4163 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4165 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4166 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4167 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4169 switch (cs->reason)
4171 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4172 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4173 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4174 break;
4176 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4177 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4178 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4179 break;
4181 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4182 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4183 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4184 break;
4186 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4187 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4188 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4189 break;
4191 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4192 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4193 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4194 break;
4196 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4197 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4198 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4199 break;
4201 case XmCR_DRAG:
4203 int slider_size;
4205 /* Get the slider size. */
4206 BLOCK_INPUT;
4207 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4208 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4210 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4211 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4212 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4213 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4215 break;
4217 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4218 break;
4221 if (part >= 0)
4223 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4224 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4225 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4230 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4231 #ifdef USE_GTK
4232 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4233 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4235 static void
4236 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4237 GtkRange *widget;
4238 gpointer data;
4240 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4241 gdouble previous;
4242 gdouble position;
4243 gdouble *p;
4244 int diff;
4246 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4247 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4249 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4251 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4252 if (! p)
4254 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4255 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4256 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4259 previous = *p;
4260 *p = position;
4262 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4264 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4266 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4268 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4269 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4271 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4273 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4274 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4276 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4278 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4279 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4281 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4283 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4284 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4286 else
4288 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4289 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4290 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4291 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4294 if (part >= 0)
4296 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4297 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4298 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4302 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4304 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4305 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4306 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4307 the thumb is. */
4309 static void
4310 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4311 Widget widget;
4312 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4314 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4315 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4316 float shown;
4317 int whole, portion, height;
4318 int part;
4320 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4321 BLOCK_INPUT;
4322 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4323 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4325 whole = 10000000;
4326 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4328 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4329 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4330 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4331 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4332 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4333 bottom). */
4334 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4335 else
4336 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4338 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4339 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4340 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4341 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4345 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4346 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4347 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4348 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4349 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4350 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4351 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4353 static void
4354 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4355 Widget widget;
4356 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4358 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4359 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4360 int position = (long) call_data;
4361 Dimension height;
4362 int part;
4364 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4365 BLOCK_INPUT;
4366 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4367 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4369 if (abs (position) >= height)
4370 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4372 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4373 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4374 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4375 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4376 else
4377 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4379 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4380 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4381 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4382 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4385 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4386 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4388 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4390 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4391 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4393 #ifdef USE_GTK
4394 static void
4395 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4396 struct frame *f;
4397 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4399 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4401 BLOCK_INPUT;
4402 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4403 scroll_bar_name);
4404 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4407 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4409 static void
4410 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4411 struct frame *f;
4412 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4414 Window xwindow;
4415 Widget widget;
4416 Arg av[20];
4417 int ac = 0;
4418 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4419 unsigned long pixel;
4421 BLOCK_INPUT;
4423 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4424 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4425 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4426 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4427 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4428 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4429 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4430 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4431 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4433 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4434 if (pixel != -1)
4436 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4437 ++ac;
4440 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4441 if (pixel != -1)
4443 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4444 ++ac;
4447 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4448 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4450 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4451 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4452 (XtPointer) bar);
4453 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4454 (XtPointer) bar);
4455 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4456 (XtPointer) bar);
4457 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4458 (XtPointer) bar);
4459 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4460 (XtPointer) bar);
4461 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4462 (XtPointer) bar);
4463 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4464 (XtPointer) bar);
4466 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4467 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4469 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4470 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4471 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4472 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4474 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4476 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4477 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4478 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4479 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4480 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4481 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4482 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4483 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4485 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4486 if (pixel != -1)
4488 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4489 ++ac;
4492 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4493 if (pixel != -1)
4495 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4496 ++ac;
4499 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4501 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4502 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4504 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4505 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4506 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4507 pixel = -1;
4508 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4510 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4512 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4513 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4514 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4515 pixel = -1;
4516 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4519 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4520 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4521 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4522 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4523 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4524 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4526 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4527 ++ac;
4529 else
4530 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4531 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4532 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4534 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4535 the shadows. */
4536 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4537 ++ac;
4539 /* Specify the colors. */
4540 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4541 if (pixel != -1)
4543 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4544 ++ac;
4546 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4547 if (pixel != -1)
4549 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4550 ++ac;
4553 #endif
4555 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4556 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4559 char *initial = "";
4560 char *val = initial;
4561 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4562 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4563 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4564 #endif
4565 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4566 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4567 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4568 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4569 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4570 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4574 /* Define callbacks. */
4575 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4576 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4577 (XtPointer) bar);
4579 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4580 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4582 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4584 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4585 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4586 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4587 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4589 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4590 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4591 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4592 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4594 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4596 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4599 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4600 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4602 #ifdef USE_GTK
4603 static void
4604 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4605 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4606 int portion, position, whole;
4608 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4611 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4612 static void
4613 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4614 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4615 int portion, position, whole;
4617 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4618 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4619 float top, shown;
4621 BLOCK_INPUT;
4623 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4625 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4626 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4627 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4628 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4629 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4630 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4631 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4632 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4633 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4634 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4635 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4636 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4637 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4638 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4639 whole += portion;
4641 if (whole <= 0)
4642 top = 0, shown = 1;
4643 else
4645 top = (float) position / whole;
4646 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4649 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4651 int size, value;
4653 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4654 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4655 value. */
4656 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4657 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4658 size = max (size, 1);
4660 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4661 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4662 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4664 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4666 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4668 if (whole == 0)
4669 top = 0, shown = 1;
4670 else
4672 top = (float) position / whole;
4673 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4677 float old_top, old_shown;
4678 Dimension height;
4679 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4680 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4681 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4682 XtNheight, &height,
4683 NULL);
4685 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4686 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4687 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4688 else
4689 top = old_top;
4690 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4691 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4693 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4694 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4695 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4696 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4698 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4699 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4700 else
4702 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4703 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4704 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4706 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4710 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4712 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4714 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4716 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4720 /************************************************************************
4721 Scroll bars, general
4722 ************************************************************************/
4724 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4725 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4726 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4727 scroll bar. */
4729 static struct scroll_bar *
4730 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4731 struct window *w;
4732 int top, left, width, height;
4734 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4735 struct scroll_bar *bar
4736 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4738 BLOCK_INPUT;
4740 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4741 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4742 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4744 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4745 unsigned long mask;
4746 Window window;
4748 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4749 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4750 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4752 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4753 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4754 | ExposureMask);
4755 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4757 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4759 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4760 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4761 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4762 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4763 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4764 left, top, width,
4765 window_box_height (w), False);
4767 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4768 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4769 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4770 top,
4771 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4772 height,
4773 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4775 CopyFromParent,
4776 CopyFromParent,
4777 CopyFromParent,
4778 /* Attributes. */
4779 mask, &a);
4780 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4782 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4784 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4785 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4786 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4787 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4788 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4789 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4790 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4791 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4793 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4794 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4795 bar->prev = Qnil;
4796 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4797 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4798 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4800 /* Map the window/widget. */
4801 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4803 #ifdef USE_GTK
4804 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4805 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4806 top,
4807 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4808 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4809 max (height, 1));
4810 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4811 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4812 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4813 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4814 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4815 top,
4816 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4817 max (height, 1), 0);
4818 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4819 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4821 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4822 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4823 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4825 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4826 return bar;
4830 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4832 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4833 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4834 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4835 events.)
4837 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4838 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4839 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4840 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4841 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4843 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4845 static void
4846 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4847 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4848 int start, end;
4849 int rebuild;
4851 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4852 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4853 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4854 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4856 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4857 if (! rebuild
4858 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4859 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4860 return;
4862 BLOCK_INPUT;
4865 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4866 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4867 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4869 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4870 the distance between start and end. */
4872 int length = end - start;
4874 if (start < 0)
4875 start = 0;
4876 else if (start > top_range)
4877 start = top_range;
4878 end = start + length;
4880 if (end < start)
4881 end = start;
4882 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4883 end = top_range;
4886 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4887 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4888 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4890 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4891 if (end > top_range)
4892 end = top_range;
4894 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4895 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4896 that many pixels tall. */
4897 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4899 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4900 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4901 if (0 < start)
4902 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4903 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4904 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4905 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4906 inside_width, start,
4907 False);
4909 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4910 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4911 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4912 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4914 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4915 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4916 /* x, y, width, height */
4917 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4918 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4919 inside_width, end - start);
4921 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4922 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4923 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4924 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4926 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4927 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4928 if (end < inside_height)
4929 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4930 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4931 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4932 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4933 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4934 False);
4938 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4941 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4943 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4944 nil. */
4946 static void
4947 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4948 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4950 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4951 BLOCK_INPUT;
4953 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4954 #ifdef USE_GTK
4955 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4956 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4957 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
4958 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4959 #else
4960 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4961 #endif
4963 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
4964 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
4966 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4970 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
4971 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
4972 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
4973 create one. */
4975 static void
4976 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
4977 struct window *w;
4978 int portion, whole, position;
4980 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4981 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4982 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
4983 int window_y, window_height;
4985 /* Get window dimensions. */
4986 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
4987 top = window_y;
4988 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
4989 height = window_height;
4991 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
4992 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
4994 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
4995 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
4996 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
4997 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
4998 else
4999 sb_width = width;
5001 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5002 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5003 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5004 sb_left = (left +
5005 (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5006 ? width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2
5007 : 0));
5008 else
5009 sb_left = (left +
5010 (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5011 ? (width - sb_width) / 2
5012 : width - sb_width));
5013 #else
5014 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5015 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5016 else
5017 sb_left = left;
5018 #endif
5020 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5021 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5023 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5025 BLOCK_INPUT;
5026 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5027 left, top, width, height, False);
5028 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5031 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5033 else
5035 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5036 unsigned int mask = 0;
5038 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5040 BLOCK_INPUT;
5042 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5043 mask |= CWX;
5044 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5045 mask |= CWY;
5046 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5047 mask |= CWWidth;
5048 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5049 mask |= CWHeight;
5051 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5053 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5054 if (mask)
5056 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5057 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5058 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5059 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5060 left, top, width, height, False);
5061 #ifdef USE_GTK
5062 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5063 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5064 top,
5065 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5066 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5067 max (height, 1));
5068 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5069 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5070 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5071 top,
5072 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5073 max (height, 1), 0);
5074 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5076 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5078 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5079 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5080 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5082 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5083 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5084 height, False);
5085 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5086 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5087 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5088 height, False);
5091 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5092 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5093 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5094 example. */
5096 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5097 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5098 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5100 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5101 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5102 left + area_width - rest, top,
5103 rest, height, False);
5104 else
5105 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5106 left, top, rest, height, False);
5110 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5111 if (mask)
5113 XWindowChanges wc;
5115 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5116 wc.y = top;
5117 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5118 wc.height = height;
5119 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5120 mask, &wc);
5123 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5125 /* Remember new settings. */
5126 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5127 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5128 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5129 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5131 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5134 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5135 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5136 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5137 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5138 dragged. */
5139 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5141 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5143 if (whole == 0)
5144 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5145 else
5147 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5148 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5149 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5152 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5154 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5158 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5159 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5160 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5161 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5162 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5163 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5164 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5166 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5167 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5168 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5170 static void
5171 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5172 FRAME_PTR frame;
5174 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5175 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5177 Lisp_Object bar;
5178 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5179 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5180 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5181 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5182 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5183 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5184 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5189 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5190 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5192 static void
5193 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5194 struct window *window;
5196 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5197 struct frame *f;
5199 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5200 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5201 abort ();
5203 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5205 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5206 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5207 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5209 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5210 the lists. */
5211 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5212 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5213 return;
5214 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5215 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5216 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5217 else
5218 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5219 one or the other! */
5220 abort ();
5222 else
5223 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5225 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5226 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5228 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5229 bar->prev = Qnil;
5230 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5231 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5232 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5235 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5236 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5238 static void
5239 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5240 FRAME_PTR f;
5242 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5244 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5246 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5247 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5248 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5250 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5252 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5254 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5256 next = b->next;
5257 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5260 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5261 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5265 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5266 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5267 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5269 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5270 mark bits. */
5272 static void
5273 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5274 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5275 XEvent *event;
5277 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5278 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5279 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5280 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5282 BLOCK_INPUT;
5284 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5286 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5287 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5288 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5289 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5291 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5292 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5294 /* x, y, width, height */
5295 0, 0,
5296 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5297 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5299 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5300 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5301 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5302 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
5304 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5307 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5309 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5310 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5312 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5313 mark bits. */
5316 static void
5317 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5318 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5319 XEvent *event;
5320 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5322 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5323 abort ();
5325 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5326 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5327 emacs_event->modifiers
5328 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5329 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5330 event->xbutton.state)
5331 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5332 ? up_modifier
5333 : down_modifier));
5334 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5335 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5336 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5338 #if 0
5339 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5340 int internal_height
5341 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5342 #endif
5343 int top_range
5344 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5345 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5347 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5348 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5350 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5351 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5352 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5353 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5354 else
5355 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5357 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5358 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5359 whether or not we're dragging. */
5360 #if 0
5361 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5362 holding it. */
5363 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5364 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5365 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5366 #endif
5368 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5369 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5370 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5371 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5373 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5374 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5376 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5377 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5379 #endif
5381 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5382 #if 0
5383 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5384 the handle. */
5385 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5386 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5387 else
5388 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5389 #else
5390 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5391 #endif
5393 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5397 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5399 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5401 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5402 mark bits. */
5404 static void
5405 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5406 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5407 XEvent *event;
5409 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5411 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5413 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5414 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5416 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5417 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5419 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5420 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5422 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5424 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5426 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5431 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5433 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5434 on the scroll bar. */
5436 static void
5437 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5438 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5439 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5440 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5441 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5442 unsigned long *time;
5444 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5445 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5446 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5447 int win_x, win_y;
5448 Window dummy_window;
5449 int dummy_coord;
5450 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5452 BLOCK_INPUT;
5454 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5455 report that. */
5456 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5458 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5459 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5460 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5462 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5463 &win_x, &win_y,
5465 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5466 &dummy_mask))
5468 else
5470 #if 0
5471 int inside_height
5472 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5473 #endif
5474 int top_range
5475 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5477 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5479 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5480 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5482 if (win_y < 0)
5483 win_y = 0;
5484 if (win_y > top_range)
5485 win_y = top_range;
5487 *fp = f;
5488 *bar_window = bar->window;
5490 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5491 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5492 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5493 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5494 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5495 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5496 else
5497 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5499 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5500 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5502 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5503 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5506 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5508 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5512 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5513 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5514 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5515 redraw them. */
5517 void
5518 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5519 FRAME_PTR f;
5521 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5522 Lisp_Object bar;
5524 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5525 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5526 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5527 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5528 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5529 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5530 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5531 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5532 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5533 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5537 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5539 #if 0
5540 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5541 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5542 sometimes don't work. */
5544 static Time enter_timestamp;
5545 #endif
5547 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5548 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5549 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5550 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5552 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5553 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5555 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5557 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5558 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5560 static int temp_index;
5561 static short temp_buffer[100];
5563 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5564 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5565 temp_index = 0; \
5566 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5568 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5569 on a particular display. */
5571 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5573 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5574 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5575 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5576 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5578 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5580 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5581 do \
5583 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5584 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5585 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5586 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5587 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5588 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5590 while (0)
5592 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5593 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5596 enum
5598 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5599 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5600 X_EVENT_DROP
5603 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5604 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5605 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5607 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5608 this event further.
5609 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5611 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5612 static int
5613 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5614 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5615 XEvent *event;
5617 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5618 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5619 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5620 was created. */
5622 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5623 event->xclient.window);
5625 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5627 #endif
5629 #ifdef USE_GTK
5630 static int current_count;
5631 static int current_finish;
5632 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5634 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5635 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5636 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5637 static GdkFilterReturn
5638 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5639 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5640 GdkEvent *ev;
5641 gpointer data;
5643 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5645 if (current_count >= 0)
5647 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5649 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5651 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5652 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5653 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5654 so we do it here. */
5655 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5656 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5657 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5658 #endif
5660 if (! dpyinfo)
5661 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5662 else
5664 current_count +=
5665 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5666 current_hold_quit);
5669 else
5670 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5672 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5673 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5675 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5677 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5680 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5682 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5683 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5684 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5686 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5688 static int
5689 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
5690 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5691 XEvent *eventp;
5692 int *finish;
5693 struct input_event *hold_quit;
5695 union {
5696 struct input_event ie;
5697 struct selection_input_event sie;
5698 } inev;
5699 int count = 0;
5700 int do_help = 0;
5701 int nbytes = 0;
5702 struct frame *f;
5703 struct coding_system coding;
5704 XEvent event = *eventp;
5706 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5708 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5709 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5710 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5712 switch (event.type)
5714 case ClientMessage:
5716 if (event.xclient.message_type
5717 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5718 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5720 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5721 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5723 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5724 could be the shell widget window
5725 if the frame has no title bar. */
5726 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5727 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5728 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5729 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5730 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5731 #endif
5732 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5733 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5734 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5735 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5736 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5737 needed.
5739 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5740 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5741 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5742 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5743 Emacs. */
5745 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5746 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5747 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5748 if (f)
5750 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5751 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5752 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5753 x_catch_errors (d);
5754 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5755 /* The ICCCM says this is
5756 the only valid choice. */
5757 RevertToParent,
5758 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5759 /* This is needed to detect the error
5760 if there is an error. */
5761 XSync (d, False);
5762 x_uncatch_errors ();
5764 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5765 #endif /* 0 */
5766 goto done;
5769 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5770 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5772 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5773 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5774 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5775 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5776 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5777 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5778 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5779 session manager and one for this. */
5780 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5781 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5782 #endif
5784 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5785 event.xclient.window);
5786 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5787 for a single Emacs process. */
5788 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5789 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5790 event.xclient.window,
5791 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5792 else if (f)
5793 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5794 event.xclient.window,
5795 0, 0);
5797 goto done;
5800 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5801 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5803 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5804 event.xclient.window);
5805 if (!f)
5806 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5808 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5809 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5810 goto done;
5813 goto done;
5816 if (event.xclient.message_type
5817 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5819 goto done;
5822 if (event.xclient.message_type
5823 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5825 int new_x, new_y;
5826 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5828 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5829 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5831 if (f)
5833 f->left_pos = new_x;
5834 f->top_pos = new_y;
5836 goto done;
5839 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5840 if (event.xclient.message_type
5841 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5843 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5844 if (f)
5845 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5846 &event, NULL);
5847 goto done;
5849 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5851 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5852 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5853 || (event.xclient.message_type
5854 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5856 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5857 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5858 currently never do because we are interested in
5859 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5860 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5861 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5862 if (!f)
5863 goto OTHER;
5864 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5865 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5866 goto done;
5869 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5870 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5871 we construct an input_event. */
5872 if (event.xclient.message_type
5873 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5875 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5876 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5877 goto done;
5879 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5881 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5882 if (!f)
5883 goto OTHER;
5884 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
5885 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5887 break;
5889 case SelectionNotify:
5890 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
5891 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5892 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5893 goto OTHER;
5894 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5895 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5896 break;
5898 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5899 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
5900 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5901 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5902 goto OTHER;
5903 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5905 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5907 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5908 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5909 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5910 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5911 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5913 break;
5915 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5916 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
5917 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5918 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5919 goto OTHER;
5920 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5922 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5923 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5925 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5926 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5927 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
5928 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5929 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
5930 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
5931 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5932 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5934 break;
5936 case PropertyNotify:
5937 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
5938 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
5939 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
5940 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
5941 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
5942 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
5943 goto OTHER;
5944 #endif
5945 #endif
5946 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5947 goto OTHER;
5949 case ReparentNotify:
5950 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5951 if (f)
5953 int x, y;
5954 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5955 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5956 f->left_pos = x;
5957 f->top_pos = y;
5959 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
5960 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
5961 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
5963 goto OTHER;
5965 case Expose:
5966 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5967 if (f)
5969 x_check_fullscreen (f);
5971 #ifdef USE_GTK
5972 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
5973 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
5974 event.xexpose.window,
5975 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5976 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
5977 FALSE);
5978 #endif
5979 if (f->async_visible == 0)
5981 f->async_visible = 1;
5982 f->async_iconified = 0;
5983 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
5984 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
5986 else
5987 expose_frame (f,
5988 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5989 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
5991 else
5993 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5994 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5995 #endif
5996 #if defined USE_LUCID
5997 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
5998 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
5999 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6001 Widget widget
6002 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6003 if (widget)
6004 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6006 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6008 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6009 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6010 goto OTHER;
6011 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6012 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6013 event.xexpose.window);
6015 if (bar)
6016 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6017 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6018 else
6019 goto OTHER;
6020 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6021 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6023 break;
6025 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6026 source area was obscured or not
6027 available. */
6028 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6029 if (f)
6031 expose_frame (f,
6032 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6033 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6034 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6036 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6037 else
6038 goto OTHER;
6039 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6040 break;
6042 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6043 source area was completely
6044 available. */
6045 break;
6047 case UnmapNotify:
6048 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6049 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6051 tip_window = 0;
6052 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6055 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6056 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6057 the frame was deleted. */
6059 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6060 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6061 display that won't ever be seen. */
6062 f->async_visible = 0;
6063 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6064 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6065 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6066 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6067 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6068 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6069 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6071 f->async_iconified = 1;
6073 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6074 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6077 goto OTHER;
6079 case MapNotify:
6080 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6081 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6082 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6083 goto OTHER;
6085 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6086 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6087 frame is visible. */
6088 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6089 if (f)
6091 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6092 the frame's display structures.
6093 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6094 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6095 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6096 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6097 if (! f->async_iconified)
6098 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6100 f->async_visible = 1;
6101 f->async_iconified = 0;
6102 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6104 if (f->iconified)
6106 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6107 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6109 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6110 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6111 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6112 to update the frame titles
6113 in case this is the second frame. */
6114 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6116 goto OTHER;
6118 case KeyPress:
6120 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6121 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6123 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6124 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6125 if (popup_activated ())
6126 goto OTHER;
6127 #endif
6129 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6131 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6132 mouse highlighting. */
6133 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6134 && (f == 0
6135 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6137 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6138 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6141 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6142 if (f == 0)
6144 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6145 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6146 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6147 event.xkey.window);
6148 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6150 widget = XtParent (widget);
6151 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6154 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6156 if (f != 0)
6158 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6159 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6160 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6161 his Emacs hang.
6163 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6164 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6165 status_return even if the input is too long to
6166 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6167 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6168 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6169 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6170 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6171 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6172 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6173 int modifiers;
6174 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6175 Lisp_Object c;
6177 #ifdef USE_GTK
6178 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6179 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6180 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6181 (see above). */
6182 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6183 #endif
6185 event.xkey.state
6186 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6187 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6188 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6190 /* This will have to go some day... */
6192 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6193 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6194 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6195 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6196 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6197 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6198 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6200 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6201 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6202 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6203 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6204 not it is combined with Meta. */
6205 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6206 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6208 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6209 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6211 Status status_return;
6213 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6214 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6215 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6216 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6217 &status_return);
6218 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6220 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6221 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6222 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6223 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6224 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6225 &status_return);
6227 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6228 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6229 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6230 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6231 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6232 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6233 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6234 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6235 &status_return);
6236 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6238 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6239 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6240 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6241 &event.xkey,
6242 copy_bufptr,
6243 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6244 &status_return);
6247 #endif
6249 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6250 break;
6251 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6253 keysym = NoSymbol;
6254 modifiers = 0;
6256 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6257 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6258 abort ();
6260 else
6261 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6262 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6263 &compose_status);
6264 #else
6265 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6266 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6267 &compose_status);
6268 #endif
6270 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6271 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6272 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6273 break;
6275 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6276 orig_keysym = keysym;
6278 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6279 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6280 inev.ie.modifiers
6281 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6282 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6284 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6285 translations to characters. */
6286 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6287 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6289 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6290 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6291 goto done_keysym;
6294 /* Keysyms directly mapped to supported Unicode characters. */
6295 if ((keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x010033ff)
6296 || (keysym >= 0x0100e000 && keysym <= 0x0100ffff))
6298 int code = keysym & 0xFFFF, charset_id, c1, c2;
6300 if (code < 0x80)
6302 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6303 inev.ie.code = code;
6305 else if (code < 0x100)
6307 if (code < 0xA0)
6308 charset_id = CHARSET_8_BIT_CONTROL;
6309 else
6310 charset_id = charset_latin_iso8859_1;
6311 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6312 inev.ie.code = MAKE_CHAR (charset_id, code, 0);
6314 else
6316 if (code < 0x2500)
6317 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_0100_24ff,
6318 code -= 0x100;
6319 else if (code < 0xE000)
6320 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_2500_33ff,
6321 code -= 0x2500;
6322 else
6323 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_e000_ffff,
6324 code -= 0xE000;
6325 c1 = (code / 96) + 32, c2 = (code % 96) + 32;
6326 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6327 inev.ie.code = MAKE_CHAR (charset_id, c1, c2);
6329 goto done_keysym;
6332 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6333 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6334 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6335 Vx_keysym_table,
6336 Qnil))))
6338 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6339 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6340 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6341 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6342 goto done_keysym;
6345 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6346 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6347 || keysym == XK_Delete
6348 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6349 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6350 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6351 #endif
6352 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6353 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6354 #ifdef HPUX
6355 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6356 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6357 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6358 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6359 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6360 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6361 #endif
6362 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6363 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6364 #endif
6365 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6366 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6367 #endif
6368 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6369 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6370 #endif
6371 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6372 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6373 #endif
6374 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6375 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6376 #endif
6377 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6378 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6379 #endif
6380 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6381 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6382 #endif
6383 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6384 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6385 #endif
6386 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6387 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6388 #endif
6389 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6390 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6391 #endif
6392 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6393 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6394 #endif
6395 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6396 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6397 #endif
6398 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6399 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6400 #endif
6401 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6402 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6403 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6404 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6405 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6406 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6407 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6408 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6409 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6410 #endif
6411 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6412 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6413 #endif
6414 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6415 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6416 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6417 don't have real modifiers but
6418 should be treated similarly to
6419 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6420 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6421 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6422 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6423 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6424 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6425 #endif
6428 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6429 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6430 key. */
6431 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6432 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6433 goto done_keysym;
6436 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6437 register int i;
6438 register int c;
6439 int nchars, len;
6441 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6442 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6443 we used just above and the locale. */
6444 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6445 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6446 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6447 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6448 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6449 gives us composition information. */
6450 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6452 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6454 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6458 /* Decode the input data. */
6459 int require;
6460 unsigned char *p;
6462 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6463 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6464 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6465 /* We explicitly disable composition handling because
6466 key data should not contain any composition sequence. */
6467 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6468 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p, nbytes, require);
6469 nbytes = coding.produced;
6470 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6471 copy_bufptr = p;
6474 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6475 character events. */
6476 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6478 if (nchars == nbytes)
6479 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6480 else
6481 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6482 nbytes - i, len);
6483 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6484 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6485 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6486 inev.ie.code = c;
6487 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6490 /* Previous code updated count by nchars rather than nbytes,
6491 but that seems bogus to me. ++kfs */
6492 count += nbytes;
6494 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6496 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6497 break;
6500 done_keysym:
6501 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6502 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6503 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6504 client. */
6505 break;
6506 #else
6507 goto OTHER;
6508 #endif
6510 case KeyRelease:
6511 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6512 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6513 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6514 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6515 client. */
6516 break;
6517 #else
6518 goto OTHER;
6519 #endif
6521 case EnterNotify:
6522 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6523 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6525 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6527 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6528 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6530 #if 0
6531 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6533 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6534 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6535 || !(f->auto_lower)
6536 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6538 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6539 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6542 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6543 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6544 #endif
6546 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6547 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6548 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6549 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6550 #ifdef USE_GTK
6551 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6552 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6553 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6554 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event);
6555 #endif
6556 goto OTHER;
6558 case FocusIn:
6559 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6560 goto OTHER;
6562 case LeaveNotify:
6563 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6564 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6566 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6567 if (f)
6569 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6571 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6572 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6573 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6574 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6577 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6578 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6579 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6580 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6581 if (any_help_event_p)
6582 do_help = -1;
6584 #ifdef USE_GTK
6585 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6586 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6587 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event);
6588 #endif
6589 goto OTHER;
6591 case FocusOut:
6592 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6593 goto OTHER;
6595 case MotionNotify:
6597 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6598 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6599 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6601 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6602 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6603 f = last_mouse_frame;
6604 else
6605 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6607 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6609 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6610 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6613 if (f)
6616 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6617 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window))
6619 Lisp_Object window;
6621 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6622 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6623 0, 0, 0, 0);
6625 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6626 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6627 will be selected only when it is active. */
6628 if (WINDOWP (window)
6629 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6630 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6631 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6632 create event iff we don't leave the
6633 selected frame. */
6634 && (focus_follows_mouse
6635 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6636 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6638 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6639 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6642 last_window=window;
6644 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6645 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6647 else
6649 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6650 struct scroll_bar *bar
6651 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6652 event.xmotion.window);
6654 if (bar)
6655 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6656 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6658 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6659 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6660 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6663 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6664 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6665 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6666 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6667 do_help = 1;
6668 goto OTHER;
6671 case ConfigureNotify:
6672 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6673 if (f)
6675 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6676 #ifdef USE_GTK
6677 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6678 event.xconfigure.height);
6679 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6680 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6681 do this one, the right one will come later.
6682 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6683 need to reset it below. */
6684 int dont_resize
6685 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6686 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6687 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6688 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6690 if (dont_resize)
6691 goto OTHER;
6693 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6694 is called by the code that handles resizing
6695 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6697 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6698 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6699 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6700 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6701 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6702 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6703 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6705 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6706 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6707 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6709 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6710 #endif
6712 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6713 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6715 #ifdef USE_GTK
6716 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6717 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6718 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6719 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6720 #endif
6722 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6724 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6725 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6728 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6729 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6730 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6731 #endif
6733 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6735 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6736 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6737 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6738 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6741 goto OTHER;
6743 case ButtonRelease:
6744 case ButtonPress:
6746 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6747 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6748 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6750 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6751 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6752 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6754 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6755 && last_mouse_frame
6756 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6757 f = last_mouse_frame;
6758 else
6759 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6761 if (f)
6763 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6764 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6765 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6767 Lisp_Object window;
6768 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6769 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6771 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6772 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6774 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6776 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6777 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6778 else
6779 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6780 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6781 event.xbutton.state));
6785 if (!tool_bar_p)
6786 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6787 if (! popup_activated ())
6788 #endif
6790 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6792 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6793 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6795 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6796 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6798 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6799 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6801 else
6802 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6805 else
6807 struct scroll_bar *bar
6808 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6809 event.xbutton.window);
6811 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6812 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6813 scroll bars. */
6814 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6816 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6817 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6819 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6820 if (bar)
6821 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6822 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6825 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6827 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6828 last_mouse_frame = f;
6830 if (!tool_bar_p)
6831 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6833 else
6834 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6836 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6837 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6838 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6839 if (f != 0)
6840 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6842 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6843 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6844 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6845 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6846 Instead, save it away
6847 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6848 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6849 if (
6850 #ifdef USE_GTK
6851 ! popup_activated ()
6853 #endif
6854 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6855 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6856 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6857 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6858 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6859 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6860 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6861 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6863 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6864 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6865 #ifdef USE_GTK
6866 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6867 #endif
6869 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6871 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6872 goto OTHER;
6875 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6876 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6877 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6879 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6881 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6882 if (f->output_data.x)
6883 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6885 else
6886 goto OTHER;
6888 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6889 else
6890 goto OTHER;
6891 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6893 break;
6895 case CirculateNotify:
6896 goto OTHER;
6898 case CirculateRequest:
6899 goto OTHER;
6901 case VisibilityNotify:
6902 goto OTHER;
6904 case MappingNotify:
6905 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6906 local cache. */
6907 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6909 case MappingModifier:
6910 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6911 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6912 case MappingKeyboard:
6913 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6915 goto OTHER;
6917 default:
6918 OTHER:
6919 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6920 BLOCK_INPUT;
6921 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6922 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6923 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6924 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6925 break;
6928 done:
6929 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6931 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6932 count++;
6935 if (do_help
6936 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6938 Lisp_Object frame;
6940 if (f)
6941 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6942 else
6943 frame = Qnil;
6945 if (do_help > 0)
6947 any_help_event_p = 1;
6948 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6949 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6951 else
6953 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6954 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6956 count++;
6959 *eventp = event;
6960 return count;
6964 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6965 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6966 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6968 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6970 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
6971 XEvent *event;
6972 Display *display;
6974 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6975 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6977 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6979 if (dpyinfo)
6980 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6982 return finish;
6986 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6987 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
6988 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6990 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6991 thus pretending to be `read'.
6993 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
6995 static int
6996 XTread_socket (sd, expected, hold_quit)
6997 register int sd;
6998 int expected;
6999 struct input_event *hold_quit;
7001 int count = 0;
7002 XEvent event;
7003 int event_found = 0;
7004 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7006 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7008 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7009 return -1;
7012 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7013 BLOCK_INPUT;
7015 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7016 input_signal_count++;
7018 ++handling_signal;
7020 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
7021 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
7022 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
7024 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
7025 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
7026 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
7027 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
7028 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
7029 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
7030 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
7031 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
7032 #endif
7034 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
7035 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
7036 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
7037 for X connections. */
7038 #ifndef SIGIO
7039 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
7040 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
7042 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
7043 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
7044 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7045 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
7047 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
7048 #endif /* SIGIO */
7049 #endif
7051 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7052 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7054 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7055 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7058 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7060 struct input_event inev;
7061 BLOCK_INPUT;
7062 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7063 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7064 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7066 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7067 count++;
7069 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7071 #endif
7073 #ifndef USE_GTK
7074 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7076 int finish;
7078 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7080 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7081 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7082 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7083 break;
7084 #endif
7085 event_found = 1;
7087 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7089 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7090 goto out;
7092 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7095 #ifdef USE_GTK
7097 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7098 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7099 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7100 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7102 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7103 from all displays. */
7105 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7107 current_count = count;
7108 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7110 gtk_main_iteration ();
7112 count = current_count;
7113 current_count = -1;
7114 current_hold_quit = 0;
7116 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7117 break;
7119 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7121 out:;
7123 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7124 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7125 if (! event_found)
7127 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7128 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7129 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7130 x_noop_count++;
7131 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7133 x_noop_count=0;
7135 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7136 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7138 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7140 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7141 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7145 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7146 raise it now. */
7147 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7148 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7150 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7151 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7154 --handling_signal;
7155 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7157 return count;
7163 /***********************************************************************
7164 Text Cursor
7165 ***********************************************************************/
7167 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7168 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7170 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7171 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7172 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7174 static void
7175 x_clip_to_row (w, row, area, gc)
7176 struct window *w;
7177 struct glyph_row *row;
7178 int area;
7179 GC gc;
7181 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7182 XRectangle clip_rect;
7183 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7185 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7187 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7188 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7189 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7190 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7191 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7193 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7197 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7199 static void
7200 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7201 struct window *w;
7202 struct glyph_row *row;
7204 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7205 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7206 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7207 int x, y, wd, h;
7208 XGCValues xgcv;
7209 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7210 GC gc;
7212 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7213 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7214 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7215 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7216 return;
7218 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7219 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7220 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7222 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7223 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7224 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7225 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7226 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7227 else
7228 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7229 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7230 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7232 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7233 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7234 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7235 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7239 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7241 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7242 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7243 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7244 --gerd. */
7246 static void
7247 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7248 struct window *w;
7249 struct glyph_row *row;
7250 int width;
7251 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7253 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7254 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7256 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7257 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7258 and mini-buffer. */
7259 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7260 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7261 return;
7263 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7264 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7265 the bar might not be in the window. */
7266 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7268 struct glyph_row *row;
7269 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7270 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7272 else
7274 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7275 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7276 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7277 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7278 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7279 XGCValues xgcv;
7281 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7282 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7283 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7284 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7285 that the glyph is legible. */
7286 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7287 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7288 else
7289 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7290 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7292 if (gc)
7293 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7294 else
7296 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7297 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7300 if (width < 0)
7301 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7302 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7304 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7305 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7307 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7308 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7309 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7310 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7311 width, row->height);
7312 else
7313 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7314 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7315 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7316 row->height - width),
7317 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7318 width);
7320 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7325 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7327 static void
7328 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7329 struct frame *f;
7330 Cursor cursor;
7332 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7336 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7338 static void
7339 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7340 struct frame *f;
7341 int x, y, width, height;
7343 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7344 x, y, width, height, False);
7348 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7350 static void
7351 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7352 struct window *w;
7353 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7354 int x, y;
7355 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7356 int on_p, active_p;
7358 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7360 if (on_p)
7362 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7363 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7365 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7366 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7368 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7369 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7371 else
7372 switch (cursor_type)
7374 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7375 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7376 break;
7378 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7379 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7380 break;
7382 case BAR_CURSOR:
7383 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7384 break;
7386 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7387 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7388 break;
7390 case NO_CURSOR:
7391 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7392 break;
7394 default:
7395 abort ();
7398 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7399 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7400 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7401 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7402 #endif
7405 #ifndef XFlush
7406 if (updating_frame != f)
7407 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7408 #endif
7412 /* Icons. */
7414 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7417 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7418 struct frame *f;
7419 Lisp_Object file;
7421 int bitmap_id;
7423 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7424 return 1;
7426 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7427 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7428 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7429 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7431 if (STRINGP (file))
7433 #ifdef USE_GTK
7434 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7435 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7436 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7437 return 0;
7438 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7439 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7440 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7442 else
7444 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7445 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7447 int rc = -1;
7449 #if defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7450 #ifdef USE_GTK
7451 if (xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7452 return 0;
7453 #else
7454 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7455 if (rc != -1)
7456 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7457 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7458 #endif /* defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS) */
7460 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7461 if (rc == -1)
7463 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_xbm_bits,
7464 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7465 if (rc == -1)
7466 return 1;
7468 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7469 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7473 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7474 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7475 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7476 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7477 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7479 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7482 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7483 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7485 return 0;
7489 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7490 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7493 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7494 struct frame *f;
7495 char *icon_name;
7497 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7498 return 1;
7500 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7502 XTextProperty text;
7503 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7504 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7505 text.format = 8;
7506 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7507 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7509 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7510 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7511 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7513 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7514 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7515 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7516 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7518 return 0;
7521 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7523 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7524 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7526 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7527 be called from a signal handler.
7530 struct x_error_message_stack {
7531 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7532 Display *dpy;
7533 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7535 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7537 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7538 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7539 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7541 static void
7542 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7543 Display *display;
7544 XErrorEvent *error;
7546 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7547 x_error_message->string,
7548 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7551 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7552 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7553 operating on.
7555 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7556 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7557 stored in *x_error_message.
7559 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7560 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7562 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7564 void x_check_errors ();
7566 void
7567 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7568 Display *dpy;
7570 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7572 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7573 XSync (dpy, False);
7575 data->dpy = dpy;
7576 data->string[0] = 0;
7577 data->prev = x_error_message;
7578 x_error_message = data;
7581 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7582 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7584 void
7585 x_uncatch_errors ()
7587 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7589 BLOCK_INPUT;
7591 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7592 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7593 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7594 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7596 tmp = x_error_message;
7597 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7598 xfree (tmp);
7599 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7602 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7603 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7604 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7606 void
7607 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7608 Display *dpy;
7609 char *format;
7611 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7612 XSync (dpy, False);
7614 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7616 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7617 bcopy (x_error_message->string, string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7618 x_uncatch_errors ();
7619 error (format, string);
7623 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7624 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7627 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7628 Display *dpy;
7630 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7631 XSync (dpy, False);
7633 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7636 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7638 void
7639 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7640 Display *dpy;
7642 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7645 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7647 void
7648 x_fully_uncatch_errors ()
7650 while (x_error_message)
7651 x_uncatch_errors ();
7654 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7657 x_catching_errors ()
7659 return x_error_message != 0;
7662 #if 0
7663 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7664 x_trace_wire ()
7666 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7668 #endif /* ! 0 */
7671 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7672 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7673 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7674 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7675 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7677 static SIGTYPE
7678 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7679 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7681 #ifdef USG
7682 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7683 must reestablish each time */
7684 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7685 #endif /* USG */
7689 /************************************************************************
7690 Handling X errors
7691 ************************************************************************/
7693 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7695 static char *error_msg;
7697 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7698 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7699 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7701 static void
7702 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7704 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7705 exit (70);
7708 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7709 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7711 static SIGTYPE
7712 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7713 Display *dpy;
7714 char *error_message;
7716 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7717 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7719 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7720 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7721 handling_signal = 0;
7723 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7724 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7725 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7726 the original message here. */
7727 x_catch_errors (dpy);
7729 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7730 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7731 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7733 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7734 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7735 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7737 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7738 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7740 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7741 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7742 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7744 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7745 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7746 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7747 if (dpyinfo)
7749 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7750 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7751 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7752 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7754 #endif
7756 #ifdef USE_GTK
7757 if (dpyinfo)
7758 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7759 #endif
7761 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7762 if (dpyinfo)
7763 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7765 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7766 that are on the dead display. */
7767 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7769 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7770 minibuf_frame
7771 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7772 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7773 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7774 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7775 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7776 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7779 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7780 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7781 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7782 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7783 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7784 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7786 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7787 trying to find a replacement. */
7788 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7789 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7792 if (dpyinfo)
7793 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7795 x_uncatch_errors ();
7797 if (x_display_list == 0)
7799 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7800 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7801 exit (70);
7804 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7805 #ifdef SIGIO
7806 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7807 #endif
7808 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7809 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7811 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7812 error ("%s", error_msg);
7815 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7816 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7817 static void x_error_quitter P_ ((Display *, XErrorEvent *));
7819 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7820 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7822 static int
7823 x_error_handler (display, error)
7824 Display *display;
7825 XErrorEvent *error;
7827 if (x_error_message)
7828 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7829 else
7830 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7831 return 0;
7834 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7835 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7836 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7838 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7840 #if __GNUC__ >= 3 /* On GCC 3.0 we might get a warning. */
7841 #define NO_INLINE __attribute__((noinline))
7842 #else
7843 #define NO_INLINE
7844 #endif
7846 /* Some versions of GNU/Linux define noinline in their headers. */
7848 #ifdef noinline
7849 #undef noinline
7850 #endif
7852 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7853 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7855 static void NO_INLINE
7856 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7857 Display *display;
7858 XErrorEvent *error;
7860 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7862 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7863 or colors that are not defined. */
7865 if (error->error_code == BadName)
7866 return;
7868 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7869 original error handler. */
7871 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7872 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7873 buf, error->request_code);
7874 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7878 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7879 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7880 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7882 static int
7883 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7884 Display *display;
7886 char buf[256];
7888 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7889 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7890 return 0;
7893 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7895 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7896 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7897 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7898 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7900 Lisp_Object
7901 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7902 struct frame *f;
7903 register char *fontname;
7905 struct font_info *fontp
7906 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7908 if (!fontp)
7909 return Qnil;
7911 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7912 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7913 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7915 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = fontp->average_width;
7916 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = fontp->space_width;
7917 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7919 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7921 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7922 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7924 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7925 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7926 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7928 else
7930 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7931 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7934 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7935 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7937 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7938 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7939 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7940 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7941 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7942 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7944 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7945 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7946 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7947 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7948 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7951 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7954 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7955 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7956 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7957 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7959 Lisp_Object
7960 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7961 struct frame *f;
7962 char *fontsetname;
7964 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7965 Lisp_Object result;
7967 if (fontset < 0)
7968 return Qnil;
7970 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7971 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7972 to do. */
7973 return fontset_name (fontset);
7975 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7977 if (!STRINGP (result))
7978 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7979 return Qnil;
7981 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7982 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7984 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7985 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7986 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7987 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7988 #endif
7990 return build_string (fontsetname);
7994 /***********************************************************************
7995 X Input Methods
7996 ***********************************************************************/
7998 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8000 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8002 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
8003 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8004 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8006 static void
8007 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
8008 XIM xim;
8009 XPointer client_data;
8010 XPointer call_data;
8012 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8013 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8015 BLOCK_INPUT;
8017 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8018 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8020 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8021 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8023 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8024 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8028 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8029 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8030 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8031 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8034 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8036 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8037 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8038 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
8039 #endif
8041 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8042 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8044 static void
8045 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8046 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8047 char *resource_name;
8049 XIM xim;
8051 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8052 if (use_xim)
8054 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8055 EMACS_CLASS);
8056 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8058 if (xim)
8060 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8061 XIMCallback destroy;
8062 #endif
8064 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8065 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8067 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8068 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8069 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8070 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8071 #endif
8075 else
8076 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8077 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8081 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8083 struct xim_inst_t
8085 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8086 char *resource_name;
8089 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8090 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8091 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8092 when the callback was registered. */
8094 static void
8095 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8096 Display *display;
8097 XPointer client_data;
8098 XPointer call_data;
8100 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8101 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8103 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8104 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8105 return;
8107 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8109 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8110 as they have no XIC. */
8111 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8113 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8115 BLOCK_INPUT;
8116 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8118 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8120 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8121 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8123 create_frame_xic (f);
8124 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8125 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8126 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8128 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8129 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8134 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8138 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8141 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8142 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8143 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8144 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8146 static void
8147 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8148 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8149 char *resource_name;
8151 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8152 if (use_xim)
8154 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8155 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8156 int len;
8158 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8159 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8160 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8161 len = strlen (resource_name);
8162 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8163 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8164 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8165 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8166 xim_instantiate_callback,
8167 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8168 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8169 least, hence the configure test. */
8170 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8171 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8172 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8173 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8174 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8177 else
8178 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8179 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8183 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8185 static void
8186 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8187 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8189 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8190 if (use_xim)
8192 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8193 if (dpyinfo->display)
8194 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8195 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8196 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8197 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8198 if (dpyinfo->display)
8199 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8200 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8201 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8203 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8206 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8210 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8211 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8213 void
8214 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8215 struct frame *f;
8217 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8219 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8220 is already for the top-left corner. */
8221 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8222 return;
8224 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8225 position that fits on the screen. */
8226 if (flags & XNegative)
8227 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8228 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos);
8231 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8233 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8234 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8235 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8237 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8238 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8239 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8240 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8241 is right, though.
8243 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8244 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8246 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8247 #endif
8249 if (flags & YNegative)
8250 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - height + f->top_pos);
8253 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8254 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8255 so the flags should correspond. */
8256 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8259 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8260 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8261 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8262 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8263 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8265 void
8266 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8267 struct frame *f;
8268 register int xoff, yoff;
8269 int change_gravity;
8271 int modified_top, modified_left;
8273 if (change_gravity != 0)
8275 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8276 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8278 f->top_pos = yoff;
8279 f->left_pos = xoff;
8280 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8281 if (xoff < 0)
8282 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8283 if (yoff < 0)
8284 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8285 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8287 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8289 BLOCK_INPUT;
8290 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8292 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8293 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8295 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8297 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8298 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8299 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8300 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8301 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8304 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8305 modified_left, modified_top);
8307 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8308 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8309 ? 1 : 0);
8311 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8312 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8313 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8314 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8315 of the frame.
8317 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8318 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8319 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8321 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8322 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8323 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8324 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8325 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8326 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8328 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8331 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8332 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8333 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8334 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8335 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Standards_2fwm_2dspec. */
8337 static int
8338 wm_supports (f, atomname)
8339 struct frame *f;
8340 const char *atomname;
8342 Atom actual_type;
8343 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8344 int i, rc, actual_format;
8345 Atom prop_atom;
8346 Window wmcheck_window;
8347 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8348 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8349 long max_len = 65536;
8350 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8351 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8352 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8353 Atom want_atom;
8355 BLOCK_INPUT;
8357 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", False);
8359 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8360 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8361 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8362 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8363 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8365 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8367 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8368 x_uncatch_errors ();
8369 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8370 return 0;
8373 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8374 XFree (tmp_data);
8376 /* Check if window exists. */
8377 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8378 x_sync (f);
8379 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8381 x_uncatch_errors ();
8382 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8383 return 0;
8386 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8388 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8389 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8390 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8391 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8392 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8393 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8395 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8396 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTED", False);
8397 tmp_data = NULL;
8398 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8399 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8400 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8401 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8403 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8405 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8406 x_uncatch_errors ();
8407 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8408 return 0;
8411 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8412 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8413 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8416 rc = 0;
8417 want_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, atomname, False);
8419 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8420 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8422 x_uncatch_errors ();
8423 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8425 return rc;
8428 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8430 static int
8431 do_ewmh_fullscreen (f)
8432 struct frame *f;
8434 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE");
8436 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8437 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8438 if (!have_net_atom)
8439 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN");
8441 if (have_net_atom)
8443 Lisp_Object frame;
8444 const char *atom = "_NET_WM_STATE";
8445 const char *fs = "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN";
8446 const char *fw = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ";
8447 const char *fh = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT";
8448 const char *what = NULL;
8450 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8452 /* If there are _NET_ atoms we assume we have extended window manager
8453 hints. */
8454 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8456 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8457 what = fs;
8458 break;
8459 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8460 what = fw;
8461 break;
8462 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8463 what = fh;
8464 break;
8467 if (what != NULL && !wm_supports (f, what)) return 0;
8470 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8471 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8472 make_number (32),
8473 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8474 Fcons
8475 (make_unibyte_string (fs,
8476 strlen (fs)),
8477 Qnil)));
8478 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8479 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8480 make_number (32),
8481 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8482 Fcons
8483 (make_unibyte_string (fh,
8484 strlen (fh)),
8485 Qnil)));
8486 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8487 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8488 make_number (32),
8489 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8490 Fcons
8491 (make_unibyte_string (fw,
8492 strlen (fw)),
8493 Qnil)));
8494 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8495 if (what != NULL)
8496 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8497 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8498 make_number (32),
8499 Fcons (make_number (1), /* Add */
8500 Fcons
8501 (make_unibyte_string (what,
8502 strlen (what)),
8503 Qnil)));
8506 return have_net_atom;
8509 static void
8510 XTfullscreen_hook (f)
8511 FRAME_PTR f;
8513 if (f->async_visible)
8515 BLOCK_INPUT;
8516 do_ewmh_fullscreen (f);
8517 x_sync (f);
8518 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8523 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8524 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8525 static void
8526 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8527 struct frame *f;
8529 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8531 int width, height, ign;
8533 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8534 return;
8536 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8538 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8540 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8541 when setting WM manager hints.
8542 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8543 x_check_expected_move. */
8544 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8546 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8547 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8548 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8550 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8551 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8556 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8557 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8558 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8559 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8560 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8561 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8562 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8564 static void
8565 x_check_expected_move (f, expected_left, expected_top)
8566 struct frame *f;
8567 int expected_left;
8568 int expected_top;
8570 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8572 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8573 window manager window around the frame. */
8575 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8577 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8579 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8581 int adjusted_left;
8582 int adjusted_top;
8584 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8585 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8586 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8588 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8590 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8591 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8593 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8594 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8596 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8598 else
8599 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8600 frame's position. */
8602 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8606 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8607 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8608 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8609 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8610 of an exact comparison. */
8612 static void
8613 x_sync_with_move (f, left, top, fuzzy)
8614 struct frame *f;
8615 int left, top, fuzzy;
8617 int count = 0;
8619 while (count++ < 50)
8621 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8623 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8624 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8625 loop. */
8627 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8628 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8630 if (fuzzy)
8632 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8633 pixels. */
8635 if (abs (current_left - left) <= 10 && abs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8636 return;
8638 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8639 return;
8642 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8643 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8645 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8649 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8650 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8651 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8652 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8654 static void
8655 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8656 struct frame *f;
8657 int change_gravity;
8658 int cols, rows;
8660 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8662 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8663 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8664 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8666 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8667 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8668 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8670 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8672 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8673 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8675 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8676 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8678 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8679 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8680 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8682 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8683 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8684 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8685 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8687 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8688 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8689 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8690 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8691 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8693 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8694 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8695 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8696 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8697 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8699 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8700 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8701 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8702 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8703 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8705 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8709 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8710 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8711 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8712 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8714 void
8715 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8716 struct frame *f;
8717 int change_gravity;
8718 int cols, rows;
8720 BLOCK_INPUT;
8722 #ifdef USE_GTK
8723 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8724 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8725 else
8726 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8727 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8729 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8731 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8732 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8733 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8734 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8735 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8736 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8737 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8738 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8739 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8741 else
8742 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8744 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8746 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8748 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8750 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8751 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8753 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8754 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8755 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8756 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8757 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8759 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8762 /* Mouse warping. */
8764 void
8765 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8766 struct frame *f;
8767 int x, y;
8769 int pix_x, pix_y;
8771 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8772 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8774 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8775 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8777 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8778 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8780 BLOCK_INPUT;
8782 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8783 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8784 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8787 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8789 void
8790 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8791 struct frame *f;
8792 int pix_x, pix_y;
8794 BLOCK_INPUT;
8796 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8797 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8798 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8801 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8803 void
8804 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8805 struct frame *f;
8807 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8808 x_raise_frame (f);
8809 #endif
8810 #if 0
8811 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8812 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8813 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8814 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8815 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8816 #endif /* ! 0 */
8819 void
8820 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8821 struct frame *f;
8823 #if 0
8824 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8825 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8826 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8827 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8828 #endif /* ! 0 */
8831 /* Raise frame F. */
8833 void
8834 x_raise_frame (f)
8835 struct frame *f;
8837 BLOCK_INPUT;
8838 if (f->async_visible)
8839 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8841 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8842 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8845 /* Lower frame F. */
8847 void
8848 x_lower_frame (f)
8849 struct frame *f;
8851 if (f->async_visible)
8853 BLOCK_INPUT;
8854 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8855 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8856 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8860 static void
8861 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8862 FRAME_PTR f;
8863 int raise_flag;
8865 if (raise_flag)
8867 /* The following code is needed for `raise-frame' to work on
8868 some versions of metacity; see Window Manager
8869 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8870 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Standards_2fwm_2dspec */
8872 #if 0
8873 /* However, on other versions (metacity 2.17.2-1.fc7), it
8874 reportedly causes hangs when resizing frames. */
8876 const char *atom = "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW";
8877 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, atom))
8879 Lisp_Object frame;
8880 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8881 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8882 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8883 make_number (32),
8884 Fcons (make_number (1),
8885 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8886 Qnil)));
8888 else
8889 #endif
8890 x_raise_frame (f);
8892 else
8893 x_lower_frame (f);
8896 /* Change of visibility. */
8898 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8899 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8900 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8901 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8902 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8903 finishes with it. */
8905 void
8906 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8907 struct frame *f;
8909 Lisp_Object type;
8910 int original_top, original_left;
8911 int retry_count = 2;
8913 retry:
8915 BLOCK_INPUT;
8917 type = x_icon_type (f);
8918 if (!NILP (type))
8919 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8921 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8923 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8924 call x_set_offset a second time
8925 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8926 before the window gets really visible. */
8927 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8928 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8929 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8931 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8933 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8934 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8935 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8936 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8937 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8938 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8939 #ifdef USE_GTK
8940 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8941 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8942 #else
8943 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8944 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8945 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8946 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8947 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8948 to come back ok without this. */
8949 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8950 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8951 #endif
8954 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8956 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8957 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8958 so that incoming events are handled. */
8960 Lisp_Object frame;
8961 int count;
8962 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8963 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8964 will set it when they are handled. */
8965 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8967 original_left = f->left_pos;
8968 original_top = f->top_pos;
8970 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8971 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8973 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8975 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8976 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8977 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8978 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8980 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8981 because the window manager may choose the position
8982 and we don't want to override it. */
8984 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8985 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8986 && previously_visible)
8988 Drawable rootw;
8989 int x, y;
8990 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8992 BLOCK_INPUT;
8994 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8995 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8996 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8997 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8998 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8999 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9000 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9001 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9002 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9004 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9005 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9006 original_left, original_top);
9008 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9011 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9013 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9014 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9015 MapNotify at all.. */
9016 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9017 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9019 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9020 x_sync (f);
9022 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9023 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9024 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9025 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9026 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9027 probably a bug. */
9028 if (input_polling_used ())
9030 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9031 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9032 handler reset it. */
9033 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
9034 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9035 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9036 poll_for_input_1 ();
9037 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9040 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9041 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9044 /* 2000-09-28: In
9046 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9047 (iconify-frame f)
9048 (raise-frame f))
9050 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9051 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9052 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9053 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9055 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
9056 goto retry;
9060 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9062 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9064 void
9065 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
9066 struct frame *f;
9068 Window window;
9070 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9071 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9073 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9074 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9075 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9077 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
9078 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
9079 return;
9080 #endif
9082 BLOCK_INPUT;
9084 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9085 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9086 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9087 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9088 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9089 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9091 #ifdef USE_GTK
9092 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9093 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9094 else
9095 #endif
9097 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9099 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9100 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9102 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9103 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9105 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
9107 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
9108 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9110 XEvent unmap;
9112 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
9113 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
9114 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9115 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
9116 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9117 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9118 False,
9119 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
9120 &unmap))
9122 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9123 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
9127 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
9128 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
9129 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
9132 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9133 just by the event that we get from the server.
9134 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9135 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9136 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9137 f->visible = 0;
9138 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9139 f->async_visible = 0;
9140 f->async_iconified = 0;
9142 x_sync (f);
9144 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9147 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9149 void
9150 x_iconify_frame (f)
9151 struct frame *f;
9153 int result;
9154 Lisp_Object type;
9156 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9157 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9158 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9160 if (f->async_iconified)
9161 return;
9163 BLOCK_INPUT;
9165 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9167 type = x_icon_type (f);
9168 if (!NILP (type))
9169 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9171 #ifdef USE_GTK
9172 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9174 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9175 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9177 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9178 f->iconified = 1;
9179 f->visible = 1;
9180 f->async_iconified = 1;
9181 f->async_visible = 0;
9182 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9183 return;
9185 #endif
9187 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9189 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9191 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9192 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9193 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9194 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9195 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9196 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9197 so we have to record it here. */
9198 f->iconified = 1;
9199 f->visible = 1;
9200 f->async_iconified = 1;
9201 f->async_visible = 0;
9202 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9203 return;
9206 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9207 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9208 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9209 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9211 if (!result)
9212 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9214 f->async_iconified = 1;
9215 f->async_visible = 0;
9218 BLOCK_INPUT;
9219 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9220 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9221 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9223 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9224 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9225 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
9226 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9228 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9229 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9231 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9232 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9234 XEvent message;
9236 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9237 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9238 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9239 message.xclient.format = 32;
9240 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9242 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9243 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9244 False,
9245 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9246 &message))
9248 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9249 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9253 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9254 IconicState. */
9255 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9257 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9259 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9260 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9263 f->async_iconified = 1;
9264 f->async_visible = 0;
9266 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9267 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9268 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9272 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9274 void
9275 x_free_frame_resources (f)
9276 struct frame *f;
9278 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9279 Lisp_Object bar;
9280 struct scroll_bar *b;
9282 BLOCK_INPUT;
9284 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9285 commands to the X server. */
9286 if (dpyinfo->display)
9288 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9289 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9291 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9292 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9293 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9294 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9295 toolkit scroll bars. */
9296 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9298 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9299 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9301 #endif
9303 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9304 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9305 free_frame_xic (f);
9306 #endif
9308 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9309 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9311 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9312 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9314 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9315 we are using a toolkit. */
9316 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9317 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9319 free_frame_menubar (f);
9320 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9322 #ifdef USE_GTK
9323 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
9324 frames. We must check and free both types. */
9325 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9327 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9328 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
9329 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
9331 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9333 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9334 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9335 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9337 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
9338 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
9339 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9340 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9341 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9342 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9344 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9345 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9346 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9347 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9348 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9349 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9350 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9351 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9352 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9353 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9354 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9355 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9356 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9357 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9358 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9360 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9361 free_frame_faces (f);
9363 x_free_gcs (f);
9364 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9367 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
9368 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9370 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9371 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9373 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9374 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9375 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9376 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9377 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9378 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9380 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9382 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9383 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9384 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9385 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9386 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9387 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9388 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9391 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9395 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9397 void
9398 x_destroy_window (f)
9399 struct frame *f;
9401 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9403 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9404 commands to the X server. */
9405 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9406 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9408 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9412 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9414 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9415 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9416 that the window now has.
9417 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9418 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9419 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9421 #ifndef USE_GTK
9422 void
9423 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9424 struct frame *f;
9425 long flags;
9426 int user_position;
9428 XSizeHints size_hints;
9430 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9431 Arg al[2];
9432 int ac = 0;
9433 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9434 #endif
9436 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9438 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9439 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9441 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9442 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9444 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9445 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9446 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9447 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9448 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9449 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9450 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9451 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9452 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9453 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9455 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9456 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9457 size_hints.max_width
9458 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9459 size_hints.max_height
9460 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9462 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9464 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9465 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9466 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9468 int base_width, base_height;
9469 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9471 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9472 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9474 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9476 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9477 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9478 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9479 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9480 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9482 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9483 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9484 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9486 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9487 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9488 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9489 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9490 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9491 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9492 #else
9493 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9494 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9495 #endif
9498 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9499 if (flags)
9501 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9502 goto no_read;
9504 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9507 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9508 long supplied_return;
9509 int value;
9511 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9512 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9513 &supplied_return);
9514 #else
9515 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9516 #endif
9518 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9519 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9520 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9521 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9522 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9523 #endif
9525 if (flags)
9526 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9527 else
9529 if (value == 0)
9530 hints.flags = 0;
9531 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9532 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9533 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9534 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9535 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9536 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9537 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9538 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9542 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9543 no_read:
9544 #endif
9546 #ifdef PWinGravity
9547 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9548 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9550 if (user_position)
9552 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9553 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9555 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9557 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9558 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9559 #else
9560 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9561 #endif
9563 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9565 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9567 void
9568 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9569 struct frame *f;
9570 int state;
9572 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9573 Arg al[1];
9575 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9576 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9577 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9578 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9580 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9581 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9583 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9584 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9587 void
9588 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9589 struct frame *f;
9590 int pixmap_id;
9592 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9594 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9595 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9596 #endif
9598 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9600 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9601 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9602 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9603 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9605 else
9607 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9608 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9609 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9610 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9611 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9612 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9613 best to explicitly give up. */
9614 #if 0
9615 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9616 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = None;
9617 #else
9618 return;
9619 #endif
9623 #ifdef USE_GTK
9625 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9626 return;
9629 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9632 Arg al[1];
9633 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9634 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9635 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9636 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9639 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9641 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9642 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9644 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9647 void
9648 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9649 struct frame *f;
9650 int icon_x, icon_y;
9652 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9654 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9655 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9656 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9658 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9662 /***********************************************************************
9663 Fonts
9664 ***********************************************************************/
9666 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9668 struct font_info *
9669 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9670 FRAME_PTR f;
9671 int font_idx;
9673 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9677 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9679 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9680 to be listed.
9682 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9684 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9685 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9686 on how many fonts to match. */
9688 Lisp_Object
9689 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9690 struct frame *f;
9691 Lisp_Object pattern;
9692 int size;
9693 int maxnames;
9695 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9696 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9697 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9698 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9699 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9700 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9701 int allow_auto_scaled_font = 0;
9703 if (size < 0)
9705 allow_auto_scaled_font = 1;
9706 size = 0;
9709 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9710 if (NILP (patterns))
9711 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9713 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9714 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9715 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9717 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9719 int num_fonts;
9720 char **names = NULL;
9722 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9723 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9724 The cache is an alist of the form:
9725 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9726 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9727 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9728 allow_auto_scaled_font ? Qt : Qnil);
9729 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9730 if (!NILP (list))
9732 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9733 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9734 goto label_cached;
9737 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9739 BLOCK_INPUT;
9740 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9742 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9744 XFontStruct *font;
9745 unsigned long value;
9747 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9748 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9750 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9751 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9752 font = NULL;
9753 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9756 if (font
9757 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9759 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9760 int len = strlen (name);
9761 char *tmp;
9763 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9764 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9765 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9766 if (len == 0)
9767 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9768 else
9770 num_fonts = 1;
9771 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9772 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9773 simple var. */
9774 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9775 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9776 XFree (name);
9779 else
9780 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9782 if (font)
9783 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9786 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9788 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9789 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9790 if (maxnames < 0)
9792 int limit;
9794 for (limit = 500;;)
9796 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9797 if (num_fonts == limit)
9799 BLOCK_INPUT;
9800 XFreeFontNames (names);
9801 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9802 limit *= 2;
9804 else
9805 break;
9808 else
9809 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9810 &num_fonts);
9812 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9814 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9815 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9816 names = NULL;
9817 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9821 x_uncatch_errors ();
9822 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9824 if (names)
9826 int i;
9828 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9829 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9830 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9832 int width = 0;
9833 char *p = names[i];
9834 int average_width = -1, resx = 0, dashes = 0;
9836 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9837 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
9838 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
9839 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
9840 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
9841 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
9842 while (*p)
9843 if (*p++ == '-')
9845 dashes++;
9846 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9847 width = atoi (p);
9848 else if (dashes == 9)
9849 resx = atoi (p);
9850 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9851 average_width = atoi (p);
9854 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
9855 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0 || resx == 0)
9857 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9858 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9860 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9861 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9862 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9863 >= 0))
9864 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9865 width of this font. */
9866 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9867 else
9868 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9869 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9874 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9876 BLOCK_INPUT;
9877 XFreeFontNames (names);
9878 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9882 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9883 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9884 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9886 label_cached:
9887 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9889 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9890 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9891 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9893 int found_size;
9895 tem = XCAR (list);
9897 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9898 continue;
9899 if (!size)
9901 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9902 continue;
9905 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9907 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9908 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9909 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9911 BLOCK_INPUT;
9912 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9913 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9914 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9915 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9917 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9918 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9919 thisinfo = NULL;
9920 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9922 x_uncatch_errors ();
9923 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9925 if (thisinfo)
9927 XSETCDR (tem,
9928 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9929 ? make_number (0)
9930 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9931 BLOCK_INPUT;
9932 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9933 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9935 else
9936 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9937 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9938 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9939 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9942 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9943 if (found_size == size)
9944 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9945 else if (found_size > 0)
9947 if (NILP (second_best))
9948 second_best = tem;
9949 else if (found_size < size)
9951 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9952 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9953 second_best = tem;
9955 else
9957 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9958 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9959 second_best = tem;
9963 if (!NILP (newlist))
9964 break;
9965 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9967 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9968 break;
9972 return newlist;
9976 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9978 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9979 font table. */
9981 static void
9982 x_check_font (f, font)
9983 struct frame *f;
9984 XFontStruct *font;
9986 int i;
9987 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9989 xassert (font != NULL);
9991 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9992 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9993 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9994 break;
9996 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9999 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
10001 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
10002 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
10003 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
10004 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
10005 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
10007 static INLINE void
10008 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
10009 XFontStruct *font;
10010 int *w, *h;
10012 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
10013 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
10015 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
10016 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
10017 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
10018 if (*w <= 0)
10019 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
10023 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
10024 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
10025 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
10026 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
10027 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
10029 static int
10030 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
10031 struct frame *f;
10033 int i;
10034 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10035 XFontStruct *font;
10036 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
10037 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
10039 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
10040 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
10042 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
10043 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10045 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
10046 int w, h;
10048 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
10049 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
10050 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
10052 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
10053 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
10056 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
10057 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
10059 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
10060 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
10061 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
10065 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
10066 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
10067 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
10068 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
10070 struct font_info *
10071 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
10072 struct frame *f;
10073 register char *fontname;
10074 int size;
10076 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10077 Lisp_Object font_names;
10079 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
10080 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
10081 we already have by comparing names. */
10082 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
10084 if (!NILP (font_names))
10086 Lisp_Object tail;
10087 int i;
10089 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10090 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
10091 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
10092 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
10093 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
10094 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
10095 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
10096 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
10099 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
10101 char *full_name;
10102 XFontStruct *font;
10103 struct font_info *fontp;
10104 unsigned long value;
10105 int i;
10107 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
10108 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
10109 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
10110 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
10111 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
10112 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
10113 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
10115 BLOCK_INPUT;
10116 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10117 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
10118 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
10120 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
10121 server. Let's just ignore it. */
10122 font = NULL;
10123 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10125 x_uncatch_errors ();
10126 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10127 if (!font)
10128 return NULL;
10130 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
10131 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
10132 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
10133 break;
10135 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
10136 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
10137 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
10139 int sz;
10140 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
10141 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
10142 dpyinfo->font_table
10143 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
10146 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
10147 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
10148 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
10150 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
10151 BLOCK_INPUT;
10152 bzero (fontp, sizeof (*fontp));
10153 fontp->font = font;
10154 fontp->font_idx = i;
10155 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
10156 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
10158 if (font->min_bounds.width == font->max_bounds.width)
10160 /* Fixed width font. */
10161 fontp->average_width = fontp->space_width = font->min_bounds.width;
10163 else
10165 XChar2b char2b;
10166 XCharStruct *pcm;
10168 char2b.byte1 = 0x00, char2b.byte2 = 0x20;
10169 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0);
10170 if (pcm)
10171 fontp->space_width = pcm->width;
10172 else
10173 fontp->space_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
10175 fontp->average_width
10176 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH, &value)
10177 ? (long) value / 10 : 0);
10178 if (fontp->average_width < 0)
10179 fontp->average_width = - fontp->average_width;
10180 if (fontp->average_width == 0)
10182 if (pcm)
10184 int width = pcm->width;
10185 for (char2b.byte2 = 33; char2b.byte2 <= 126; char2b.byte2++)
10186 if ((pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0)) != NULL)
10187 width += pcm->width;
10188 fontp->average_width = width / 95;
10190 else
10191 fontp->average_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
10195 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
10196 full_name = 0;
10197 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
10199 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
10200 char *p = name;
10201 int dashes = 0;
10203 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
10204 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
10205 so don't use it.
10206 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
10207 stored in them. */
10208 while (*p)
10210 if (*p == '-')
10211 dashes++;
10212 p++;
10215 if (dashes >= 13)
10217 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
10218 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
10221 XFree (name);
10224 if (full_name != 0)
10225 fontp->full_name = full_name;
10226 else
10227 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
10229 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
10230 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
10232 if (NILP (font_names))
10234 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
10235 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
10236 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
10237 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
10238 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
10239 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
10240 Qnil);
10242 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
10243 Fcons (Fcons (key,
10244 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
10245 make_number (fontp->size)),
10246 Qnil)),
10247 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
10248 if (full_name)
10250 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
10251 Qnil);
10252 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
10253 Fcons (Fcons (key,
10254 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
10255 make_number (fontp->size)),
10256 Qnil)),
10257 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
10261 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
10262 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
10263 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
10264 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
10265 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
10266 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
10267 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
10268 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
10269 fontp->encoding[1]
10270 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
10271 /* 1-byte font */
10272 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10273 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10274 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
10275 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
10276 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
10277 /* 2-byte font */
10278 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
10279 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
10280 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10281 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10282 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
10283 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
10284 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
10285 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
10286 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10287 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10288 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
10289 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
10290 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
10292 fontp->baseline_offset
10293 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
10294 ? (long) value : 0);
10295 fontp->relative_compose
10296 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
10297 ? (long) value : 0);
10298 fontp->default_ascent
10299 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
10300 ? (long) value : 0);
10302 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
10303 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
10304 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
10305 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
10306 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
10307 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
10308 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10309 return fontp;
10314 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
10315 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
10317 struct font_info *
10318 x_query_font (f, fontname)
10319 struct frame *f;
10320 register char *fontname;
10322 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10323 int i;
10325 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10326 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
10327 && (!xstricmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
10328 || !xstricmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
10329 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
10330 return NULL;
10334 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
10335 `encoder' of the structure. */
10337 void
10338 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
10339 struct font_info *fontp;
10341 Lisp_Object list, elt;
10343 elt = Qnil;
10344 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
10346 elt = XCAR (list);
10347 if (CONSP (elt)
10348 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
10349 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
10350 >= 0)
10351 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
10352 >= 0)))
10353 break;
10356 if (! NILP (list))
10358 struct ccl_program *ccl
10359 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
10361 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
10362 xfree (ccl);
10363 else
10364 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
10370 /***********************************************************************
10371 Initialization
10372 ***********************************************************************/
10374 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10375 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
10376 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10377 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
10379 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10380 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10381 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10383 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10384 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10385 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10386 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10387 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10388 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10389 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
10392 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
10394 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
10396 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10398 static int x_initialized;
10400 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10401 static int x_session_initialized;
10402 #endif
10404 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10405 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10406 the screen number from the server number. */
10407 static int
10408 same_x_server (name1, name2)
10409 const char *name1, *name2;
10411 int seen_colon = 0;
10412 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
10413 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10414 int length_until_period = 0;
10416 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10417 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10418 length_until_period++;
10420 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10421 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10422 name1 += 4;
10423 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10424 name2 += 4;
10425 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10426 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10427 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10428 name1 += system_name_length;
10429 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10430 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10431 name2 += system_name_length;
10432 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10433 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10434 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10435 name1 += length_until_period;
10436 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10437 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10438 name2 += length_until_period;
10440 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10442 if (*name1 == ':')
10443 seen_colon++;
10444 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10445 return 1;
10447 return (seen_colon
10448 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10449 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10451 #endif
10453 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10454 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10455 to 5. */
10456 static void
10457 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
10458 unsigned long mask;
10459 int *bits;
10460 int *offset;
10462 int nr = 0;
10463 int off = 0;
10465 while (!(mask & 1))
10467 off++;
10468 mask >>= 1;
10471 while (mask & 1)
10473 nr++;
10474 mask >>= 1;
10477 *offset = off;
10478 *bits = nr;
10482 x_display_ok (display)
10483 const char * display;
10485 int dpy_ok = 1;
10486 Display *dpy;
10488 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
10489 if (dpy)
10490 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
10491 else
10492 dpy_ok = 0;
10493 return dpy_ok;
10496 struct x_display_info *
10497 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10498 Lisp_Object display_name;
10499 char *xrm_option;
10500 char *resource_name;
10502 int connection;
10503 Display *dpy;
10504 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10505 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10507 BLOCK_INPUT;
10509 if (!x_initialized)
10511 x_initialize ();
10512 ++x_initialized;
10515 #ifdef USE_GTK
10517 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10518 int argc;
10519 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10520 char **argv2 = argv;
10521 GdkAtom atom;
10523 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10525 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
10526 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
10527 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
10528 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
10529 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
10531 else
10533 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10534 argv[argc] = 0;
10536 argc = 0;
10537 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10539 if (! NILP (display_name))
10541 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10542 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10545 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10546 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10548 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10549 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10550 #endif
10552 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10554 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10555 fixup_locale ();
10556 xg_initialize ();
10558 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10560 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10561 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10563 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10565 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10566 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10568 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10569 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10571 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10572 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10575 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10576 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10579 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10580 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10581 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10582 errors with X11R5:
10583 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10584 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10585 So let's not use it until R6. */
10586 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10587 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10588 #endif
10591 int argc = 0;
10592 char *argv[3];
10594 argv[0] = "";
10595 argc = 1;
10596 if (xrm_option)
10598 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10599 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10601 turn_on_atimers (0);
10602 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10603 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10604 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10605 &argc, argv);
10606 turn_on_atimers (1);
10608 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10609 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10610 fixup_locale ();
10611 #endif
10614 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10615 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10616 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10617 #endif
10618 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10619 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10620 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10622 /* Detect failure. */
10623 if (dpy == 0)
10625 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10626 return 0;
10629 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10631 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10632 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10634 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10636 struct x_display_info *share;
10637 Lisp_Object tail;
10639 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10640 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10641 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10642 SDATA (display_name)))
10643 break;
10644 if (share)
10645 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10646 else
10648 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10649 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10650 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10652 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10653 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10654 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10655 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10656 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
10657 BLOCK_INPUT;
10660 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10661 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10662 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10663 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10664 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10665 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10666 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10668 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10670 #endif
10672 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10673 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10674 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10676 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10677 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10678 x_display_name_list);
10679 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10681 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10683 #if 0
10684 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10685 #endif /* ! 0 */
10687 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10688 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10689 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10690 + 2);
10691 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10692 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10694 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10695 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10697 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10698 #ifdef USE_GTK
10699 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10700 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10701 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10703 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10704 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10706 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10707 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10708 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10709 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10710 #else
10711 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10712 #endif
10713 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10714 all versions. */
10715 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10717 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10718 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10719 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10720 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10721 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10722 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10723 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10724 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10725 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10726 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10727 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10728 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10729 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10730 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10731 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10732 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10733 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10734 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10735 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10736 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10737 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10738 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10739 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10740 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10741 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10742 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10743 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10744 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10745 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10746 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10747 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10748 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10749 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10751 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10752 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10753 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10755 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10757 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10758 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10759 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10760 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10761 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10762 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10765 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10766 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10768 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10770 Lisp_Object value;
10771 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10772 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10773 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10774 Qnil, Qnil);
10775 if (STRINGP (value)
10776 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10777 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10778 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10781 else
10782 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10783 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10786 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10787 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10788 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10789 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10790 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10791 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10792 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10793 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10794 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10797 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10798 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10799 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10800 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10801 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10802 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10803 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10804 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10805 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10806 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10807 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10808 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10809 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10810 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10811 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10812 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10813 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10814 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10815 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10816 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10817 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10818 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10819 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10820 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10821 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10822 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10823 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10824 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10825 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10826 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10827 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10828 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10829 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10830 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10831 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10832 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10833 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10834 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10835 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10836 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10837 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10838 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10839 /* For properties of font. */
10840 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10841 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10842 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
10843 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
10844 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10845 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10846 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10847 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10848 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10849 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10851 /* Ghostscript support. */
10852 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10853 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10855 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10856 False);
10858 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10860 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10861 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10862 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10863 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10865 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10866 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10867 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10869 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10870 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10873 char null_bits[1];
10875 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10877 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10878 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10879 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10884 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10885 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10886 dpyinfo->gray
10887 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10888 gray_bitmap_bits,
10889 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10890 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10893 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10894 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10895 #endif
10897 #ifdef subprocesses
10898 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10899 if (connection != 0)
10900 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10901 #endif
10903 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10904 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10905 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10906 /* stdin is a socket here */
10907 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10908 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10909 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10910 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10911 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10912 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10914 #ifdef SIGIO
10915 if (interrupt_input)
10916 init_sigio (connection);
10917 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10919 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10920 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10921 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10922 so that Xt does not crash. */
10924 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10925 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10926 Font font;
10928 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10929 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10930 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10931 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10932 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10933 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10934 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10935 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10936 abort ();
10937 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10938 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10939 x_uncatch_errors ();
10941 #endif
10942 #endif
10944 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10945 for debugging X code. */
10947 Lisp_Object value;
10948 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10949 build_string ("synchronous"),
10950 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10951 Qnil, Qnil);
10952 if (STRINGP (value)
10953 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10954 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10955 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10959 Lisp_Object value;
10960 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10961 build_string ("useXIM"),
10962 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10963 Qnil, Qnil);
10964 #ifdef USE_XIM
10965 if (STRINGP (value)
10966 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10967 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10968 use_xim = 0;
10969 #else
10970 if (STRINGP (value)
10971 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
10972 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
10973 use_xim = 1;
10974 #endif
10977 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10978 /* Only do this for the first display. */
10979 if (!x_session_initialized++)
10980 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10981 #endif
10983 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10985 return dpyinfo;
10988 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10989 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10991 void
10992 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10993 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10995 int i;
10997 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10999 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
11000 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
11001 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
11002 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
11003 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
11004 else
11006 Lisp_Object tail;
11008 tail = x_display_name_list;
11009 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
11011 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
11013 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
11014 break;
11016 tail = XCDR (tail);
11020 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
11021 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
11023 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
11024 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
11025 else
11027 struct x_display_info *tail;
11029 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
11030 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
11031 tail->next = tail->next->next;
11034 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
11035 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
11036 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
11037 #endif
11038 #endif
11039 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
11040 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
11041 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
11042 #endif
11043 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11044 if (dpyinfo->xim)
11045 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
11046 #endif
11048 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
11049 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
11050 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
11052 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name != dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name)
11053 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name);
11054 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name);
11057 if (dpyinfo->font_table)
11059 if (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder)
11060 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder);
11061 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
11063 if (dpyinfo->x_id_name)
11064 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
11065 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
11066 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
11067 xfree (dpyinfo);
11070 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11072 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
11073 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
11074 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
11075 that slows us down. */
11077 static void
11078 x_process_timeouts (timer)
11079 struct atimer *timer;
11081 BLOCK_INPUT;
11082 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
11083 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
11085 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
11086 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
11087 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
11088 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
11090 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11093 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
11094 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
11095 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
11096 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
11097 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
11098 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
11099 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
11101 void
11102 x_activate_timeout_atimer ()
11104 BLOCK_INPUT;
11105 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
11107 EMACS_TIME interval;
11109 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
11110 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
11111 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
11113 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11116 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11119 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
11121 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
11123 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
11125 x_frame_parm_handlers,
11126 x_produce_glyphs,
11127 x_write_glyphs,
11128 x_insert_glyphs,
11129 x_clear_end_of_line,
11130 x_scroll_run,
11131 x_after_update_window_line,
11132 x_update_window_begin,
11133 x_update_window_end,
11134 x_cursor_to,
11135 x_flush,
11136 #ifdef XFlush
11137 x_flush,
11138 #else
11139 0, /* flush_display_optional */
11140 #endif
11141 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
11142 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
11143 x_fix_overlapping_area,
11144 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
11145 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
11146 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
11147 x_per_char_metric,
11148 x_encode_char,
11149 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
11150 x_draw_glyph_string,
11151 x_define_frame_cursor,
11152 x_clear_frame_area,
11153 x_draw_window_cursor,
11154 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
11155 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
11158 void
11159 x_initialize ()
11161 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
11163 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
11164 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
11165 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
11166 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
11167 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
11168 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
11169 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
11170 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
11171 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
11172 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
11173 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
11174 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
11175 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
11176 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
11177 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
11178 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
11179 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
11180 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
11181 fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
11183 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
11184 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
11185 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
11186 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
11187 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
11188 off the bottom */
11189 baud_rate = 19200;
11191 x_noop_count = 0;
11192 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
11193 any_help_event_p = 0;
11194 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
11195 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
11196 x_session_initialized = 0;
11197 #endif
11199 #ifdef USE_GTK
11200 current_count = -1;
11201 #endif
11203 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
11204 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
11206 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11207 XtToolkitInitialize ();
11209 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
11211 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
11212 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
11213 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
11214 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
11215 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
11216 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
11217 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
11219 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
11220 #endif
11222 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11223 #ifndef USE_GTK
11224 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
11225 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
11226 #endif
11227 #endif
11229 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
11230 original error handler. */
11231 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
11232 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
11234 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
11235 #ifdef SIGWINCH
11236 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
11237 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
11239 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
11243 void
11244 syms_of_xterm ()
11246 x_error_message = NULL;
11248 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
11249 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
11251 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
11252 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
11254 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
11255 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
11257 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
11258 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
11259 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
11260 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
11262 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
11263 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
11265 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
11266 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
11267 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
11268 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
11269 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
11270 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
11271 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
11273 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
11274 &x_underline_at_descent_line,
11275 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
11276 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
11277 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
11278 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
11279 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
11281 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
11282 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
11283 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
11284 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
11285 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
11286 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
11287 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
11288 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
11289 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
11291 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
11292 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
11293 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
11294 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
11295 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11296 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
11297 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
11298 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
11299 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
11300 #elif USE_GTK
11301 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
11302 #else
11303 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
11304 #endif
11305 #else
11306 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
11307 #endif
11309 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
11310 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
11312 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
11313 Qalt = intern ("alt");
11314 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
11315 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
11316 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
11317 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
11318 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
11319 Qsuper = intern ("super");
11320 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
11322 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
11323 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
11324 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11325 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
11326 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
11327 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
11329 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
11330 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
11331 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11332 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
11333 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
11334 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
11336 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
11337 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
11338 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11339 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
11340 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
11341 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
11343 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
11344 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
11345 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11346 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
11347 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
11348 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
11350 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
11351 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
11352 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
11353 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
11354 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
11355 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
11358 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
11360 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
11361 (do not change this comment) */